Attached files

file filename
EX-31.1 - CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 - FUND.COM INC.f10k2009ex31i_fund.htm
EX-21.1 - SUBSIDIARIES - FUND.COM INC.f10k2009ex21i_fund.htm
EX-32.1 - CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 - FUND.COM INC.f10k2009ex32i_fund.htm
EX-31.2 - CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 - FUND.COM INC.f10k2009ex31ii_fund.htm
EX-32.2 - CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002 - FUND.COM INC.f10k2009ex32ii_fund.htm


UNITED STATES
 SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

Form 10-K

x
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
   
 
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009
   
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
   
 
For the transition period from __________ to __________

Commission File Number: 001-34027
 
  FUND.COM INC.  
  (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)  
 
Delaware
 
30-0284778
(State or other jurisdiction of
 
(I.R.S. Employer
incorporation or organization)
 
Identification No.)

14 Wall Street, 20th Floor, New York, New York 10005
(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:
(212) 618-1633

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
None

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
None
________________
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act.  Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes  x      No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  Yes  ¨    No  x
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
Large accelerated filer   o Accelerated filer  o
Non-accelerated filer
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
o Smaller reporting company  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  Yes  ¨     No  x

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant was approximately $85,970,300 as of June 30, 2009 (the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter).

As of March 31, 2010, 69,465,905 shares of the registrant’s Class A Common Stock, par value $.001 per share, and 5,462,665 shares of Class B Common Stock, par value $.001 per share, were issued and outstanding.

Documents Incorporated by Reference: None.

 
 

 
 
FUND.COM INC.

2009 FORM 10-K ANNUAL REPORT

TABLE OF CONTENTS

   
Page
PART I
   
     
Item 1.
1
Item 1A.
15
Item 1B.
34
Item 2.
34
Item 3.
34
Item 4.
35
     
PART II
   
     
Item 5.
36
Item 6.
39
Item 7.
39
Item 7A.
54
Item 8.
F-1-F-22
Item 9.
55
Item 9A.
55
Item 9B.
59
     
PART III
   
     
Item 10.
60
Item 11.
64
Item 12.
73
Item 13.
74
Item 14.
75
     
PART IV
   
     
Item 15.
76
Signatures
80
 
 
 

 

PART I

Cautionary Statement Concerning Forward-Looking Statements
 
Our representatives and we may from time to time make written or oral statements that are "forward-looking," including statements contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K and other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission, reports to our stockholders and news releases. All statements that express expectations, estimates, forecasts or projections are forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Act. In addition, other written or oral statements which constitute forward-looking statements may be made by us or on our behalf. Words such as "expects," "anticipates," "intends," "plans," "believes," "seeks," "estimates," "projects," "forecasts," "may," "should," variations of such words and similar expressions are intended to identify such forward-looking statements. These statements are not guarantees of future performance and involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions which are difficult to predict. These risks may relate to, without limitation:

    ·      
although we believe our status has changed as a result of our acquisition of Weston Capital on March 29, 2010, as of December 31, 2009 we were still in the stage of development and have earned limited revenue to date;
 
    ·      
excluding our Weston Capital subsidiary, we have a limited operating history, which limits the information available to you to evaluate our business, and have a history of operating losses and uncertain future profitability;

    ·      
we will require substantial additional financing;

    ·      
the interests of our controlling shareholders could conflict with those of our other shareholders resulting in the approval of corporate actions that are not in your interests;

    ·      
we may be exposed to risks relating to our disclosure controls and our internal controls and may need to incur significant costs to comply with applicable requirements;

    ·      
if we are unable to establish appropriate internal financial reporting controls and procedures, it could cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations, result in the restatement of our financial statements, harm our operating results, subject us to regulatory scrutiny and sanction, cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information and have a negative effect on the market price for shares of our common stock;

    ·      
we may issue additional shares of preferred stock that could defer a change of control or dilute the interests of our common shareholders and our charter documents could defer a takeover effort, which could inhibit your ability to receive an acquisition premium for your shares or your ability to sell your shares of common stock;

    ·      
we depend on the services of our executive officers, and a loss of any of these individuals may harm our business;

    ·      
our future is dependent on the successful development of the Company’s technology, products and services;

    ·      
the market acceptance of a new investment content provider is uncertain;

    ·      
we will need to expand our skilled personnel and retain those personnel that we do hire;

    ·      
we will need to successfully manage our growth, which we expect to be significant for the foreseeable future;

    ·      
we must reach agreements with third parties to supply us with the hardware, software and infrastructure necessary to provide our services, and the loss of access to this hardware, software or infrastructure or any decline or obsolescence in functionality could cause our customers’ businesses to suffer, which, in turn, could decrease our revenues and increase our costs;

    ·      
we may be impacted by general economic conditions, which would negatively affect our business;

    ·      
the rates we charge for our services may decline over time, which would reduce our revenues and adversely affect our profitability;
 
 
 

 
 
    ·      
the market for web investment content is competitive;

    ·      
if we are unable to develop our web services and content, our business will suffer;

    ·      
any factors that limit the amount advertisers are willing to spend on advertising on our web sites could have a material adverse effect on our business;

    ·      
if we fail to detect click-through fraud or unscrupulous advertisers, we could lose the confidence of our advertisers, thereby causing our business to suffer;

    ·      
we face government regulation and legal uncertainties, which could increase our costs or limit our business opportunities;

    ·      
risks related to our Exchange Traded Funds;

    ·      
risks related to our Investment Management business;

    ·      
risks related to our Professional Employer Organization business; and

    ·      
risks related to our Educational Content business.

Therefore, actual outcomes and results may differ materially from what is expressed or forecasted in or suggested by such forward-looking statements. We undertake no obligation to publicly revise these forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances that arise after the date hereof. Readers should carefully review the factors described herein and in other documents we file from time to time with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including our Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Annual Reports on Form 10-K, and any Current Reports on Form 8-K filed by us.
 
 

 
 

Overview

Fund.com Inc. (the “Company,” “we”, “us” or “our”) is a provider of fund management products and risk management solutions that help financial advisors, wealth managers, institutions, and ultra-high-net-worth families create and manage wealth. We also offer services and investment fund information to the mass-market individual investor over the Internet at www.fund.com. As of April 15, 2010, through our subsidiaries, we manage and earn fees on over $1.0 billion in client assets.

Our wealth management business solutions include:

·  
ETF Platform. An outsourced platform for launching actively managed exchange traded funds (ETFs) for banks, trust companies, independent wealth advisers, and investment managers who desire to issue and manage ETFs on a white-label basis;
·  
Regulatory Authority. Outsourced administration and compliance for ETFs, including the use of specialized regulatory authority granted to us by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) permitting the discretionary active management of assets within an ETF to meet the investment objectives of the ETF and ETF manager;
·  
Investment Products. A wealth management business catering to institutional and ultra-high-net-worth clients seeking investment in hedge funds offering a family of hedge fund and fund of funds investment products;
·  
Fund Distribution. A 17-year-old established fund distribution business that sells and markets various fund products; and
·  
Online Lead Generation. A user friendly website accessible on the Internet through a unique and recognizable top-level domain name that is intended to engage individual investors as an online educational resource and then to match their investment needs with providers of retirement solutions and investment funds, including ETFs.

Through our AdvisorShares Investments LLC subsidiary (“AdvisorShares”), we have developed an investment platform that originates and sells a new investment product known as actively managed exchange traded funds (“ETFs”).  We believe that AdvisorShares is one of limited number of companies that have received an exemption from the SEC to originate, market and sell actively managed ETFs.  AdvisorShares sells such ETF products in conjunction with leading investment managers who are responsible for managing the assets within the ETFs we create.

As reported by Blackstone Research, as of the end of February 2010, the U.S. ETF market had an aggregate of approximately $764.6 billion in total net assets.  Accordingly, we believe that the ETF market continues to experience rapid growth and represents a widely accepted financial innovation.  

The business of AdvisorShares is to develop a diverse range of "actively managed" ETFs together with established third party asset managers, and to list these ETFs on the New York Stock Exchange, or a similar national or international securities exchange. The target clients of AdvisorShares are third party investment advisors who already manage clients' assets, have a favorable track record and desire to package their investment strategy using exchange-traded funds.  Under our business model, the investment manager acts as a “sub-advisor” to the fund and selects and supervises the investments of its individual ETF.  By accessing the AdvisorShares ETF platform, third party investment managers will be able to establish their own branded, or "white-labeled," ETF on a "turn-key" basis, wherein AdvisorShares is responsible, among other things, for the compliance and administration of the fund.  AdvisorShares and the investment manager share in the fee income, subject to a monthly minimum paid to AdvisorShares.

An “actively managed” ETF is not an index fund that seeks to replicate the performance of a specified index.  An actively managed ETF uses an active investment strategy to meet its investment objectives. As a result, each of the investment sub-advisors to AdvisorShares ETFs has discretion on a daily basis to manage the fund’s portfolio in accordance with its stated investment objectives.
 
On March 29, 2010, we consummated the acquisition of 100% of the membership interests of Weston Capital Management, LLC (“Weston Capital”).  Founded in 1993 and headquartered in West Palm Beach, FL, Weston Capital has three lines of business: it originates and markets fund of funds; it originates and markets single-manager hedge funds; and it raises capital to seed new hedge funds.  Weston Capital currently earns fees on assets exceeding $1.0 billion under management.  Its founder Albert Hallac continues as CEO of Weston Capital, directing its day-to-day operations and business strategy, and our Chairman Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of Weston Capital. Weston Capital also has offices in London and New York City.   Management believes with Weston Capital’s operations, when aligned with our majority interest in AdvisorShares, will enable us to accelerate increases of assets under management since we now has the ability to seed, originate and distribute hedge funds as well as seed, originate, develop and distribute actively traded ETFs to institutional and retail investors. 
 
 
1

 
 
Consistent with our focus of providing financial content, the Company also recently consummated two strategic investments.  They consisted of the acquisition of 100% of the capital stock of Whyte Lyon Socratic Inc., d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy”, a Delaware corporation (“Whyte Lyon”) and an investment in the equity of Vensure Employer Services, Inc., an Arizona corporation (“Vensure”).  Both transactions were consummated on November 2, 2009, but were deemed to be effective as of September 29, 2009.
 
Whyte Lyon is a development stage online provider of financial literacy video content delivered over the Internet. Sometimes referred to as distance learning, such remote educational content is designed to assist on-line students to:

·
 develop the necessary skills to understand financial transactions and financial markets;
·
 develop money management skills to help them manage their income and wealth; and
·
 reach particular goals, including homeownership, debt reconciliation, or improved credit reports.
  
Simultaneous with our acquisition of Whyte Lyon, we purchased an equity interest in Vensure Employer Services, Inc., a professional employer organization, or PEO, located in Mesa, Arizona.  Vensure provides a broad range of services to small and medium-sized businesses, consisting of benefits and payroll administration, health and workers’ compensation insurance programs, personnel records management, employer liability management, employee recruiting and selection, employee performance management, employee training and development services and retirement obligations, including a retirement services product line that offers a variety of options to clients like 401(k) plans, profit sharing, and money purchase plans.

We also publish information online about investment funds at www.fund.com. Our objective is to engage individual investors as an online educational and research resource and then to match their investment needs with fund product providers, including ETFs offered by investment managers that use our ETF platform as well as investment products managed by Weston Capital. We earn investment management fees as both (i) a percentage of assets in our ETFs, which we share with the investment managers, and (ii) a percentage of assets managed by Weston Capital.  We, therefore, have an economic incentive to assist in increasing assets under management through client referrals derived from our online businesses.
 
Our plan of operation is to continue the further development of our website. This may include certain capital expenditures for technology, content and database management, including certain online advertising systems and affiliate marketing systems that management believes will assist in executing our customer acquisition business plan. Our website is anticipated to evolve over time as we introduce new content and features and generally seek to improve the customer experience. Our website was launched in March 2009 with the full planned feature set accessible at www.fund.com. We continue to seek strategic relationships that will further enhance the website development and usage.
 
Our principal executive office is located at 14 Wall Street, 20th Floor, New York, New York 10005.  Our telephone number is (212) 618-1633.  We maintain a website at www.fund.com and AdvisorShares maintains a website at www.advisorshares.com.  These websites, and the information contained therein, are not part of this annual report.

AdvisorShares Investments, LLC

The business of AdvisorShares is to develop a diverse range of "actively managed" ETFs together with established third party asset managers, and to list these ETFs on the New York Stock Exchange, or a similar national or international securities exchange. The target clients of AdvisorShares are third party investment advisors who already manage clients' assets, have a favorable track record and desire to package their investment strategy using exchange-traded funds.  Under our business model, the investment manager acts as a “sub-advisor” to the fund and selects and supervises the investments of its individual ETF.  By accessing the AdvisorShares ETF platform, third party investment managers will be able to establish their own branded, or "white-labeled," ETF on a "turn-key" basis, wherein AdvisorShares is responsible, among other things, for the compliance and administration of the fund.  AdvisorShares and the investment manager share in the fee income, subject to a monthly minimum paid to AdvisorShares.
 
 
2

 
 
ETFs offer public investors an undivided interest in a pool of securities and other assets and thus are similar in many ways to traditional mutual funds, except that shares in an ETF can be bought and sold throughout the day like stocks on a securities exchange through a broker-dealer. Unlike traditional mutual funds, ETFs do not sell or redeem their individual shares at net asset value, or NAV. Instead, financial institutions purchase and redeem ETF shares directly from the ETF, but only in large blocks, varying in size by ETF from 25,000 to 200,000 shares, called "creation units." Purchases and redemptions of the creation units generally are in kind, with the institutional investor contributing or receiving a basket of securities of the same type and proportion held by the ETF, although some ETFs may require or permit a purchasing or redeeming shareholder to substitute cash for some or all of the securities in the basket of assets.
 
Unlike conventional mutual funds, shares of the ETFs may be created and redeemed, principally in-kind, in creation units at each day’s next calculated net asset value (“NAV”). These creation and redemption arrangements are designed to protect ongoing shareholders from the adverse effects on the portfolio of the ETFs that could arise from frequent cash creation and redemption transactions. In a conventional mutual fund, redemptions can have an adverse tax impact on taxable shareholders because of the mutual fund’s need to sell portfolio securities to obtain cash to meet fund redemptions. These sales may generate taxable gains for the shareholders of the mutual funds, whereas the ETFs’ in-kind redemption mechanism generally will not lead to a tax event for ETFs or its ongoing shareholders.

We believe that investing in a publicly traded ETF significantly enhances the individual investor’s liquidity as, unlike a mutual fund or hedge fund, the investor can buy and sell the ETF as a listed security on a major stock exchange, such as the NYSE.  We also believe that investment managers will be able to increase their assets under management and improve their client distribution opportunities, as publicly traded ETFs showcase the investment track record of the investment manager and its clients are able to allocate money to the investment manager simply by buying the ETF.
 
The AdvisorShares acquisition enhances our strategic goal of connecting individual investors with appropriate diversified investment products and to also assist asset fund managers in building client assets under management by connecting them to individual investors. We believe that ETFs are one of the most significant products developed since money market funds in the 1970’s with approximately $764.6 billion in total assets as of February 2010, which represents an increase of 2.4% from approximately $746.9 billion in total assets as of December 2009, and an increase of 67.9% from approximately $455.5 billion in total assets as of February 2009. According to Morningstar, solid market performance was responsible for 73.8% of the month-over-month change in net assets, while investor inflows contributed the remaining 26.2%. On a year-over-year basis, market performance accounted for about 58.8% of U.S. ETF industry asset growth, with investor inflows representing the remaining 41.2%. We also believe that economic conditions for ETFs continue to be highly favorable in the United States inasmuch as ETFs are the mutual fund industry's fastest-growing marketplace. The Company believes that many of these Registered Investment Advisors (“RIAs”) are potential partners for AdvisorShares.
 
To date, we have used our ETF platform to complete one initial public offering in September 2009, known as the Dent Tactical ETF (NYSE: DENT), which is currently trading on the New York Stock Exchange.  The Dent Tactical ETF is sub-advised by H.S. Dent Investment Management LLC.  Harvey S. Dent previously sub-advised a $1.7 billion mutual fund known as the Dent Demographic Trends Fund.  We currently have two additional ETFs, the registrations of which have been declared effective by the SEC.  These additional ETFs are known as the WCM/BNY Mellon Focused Growth ADR ETF (NYSE: AADR) and the Mars Hill Global Relative Value ETF (NYSE: GRV). These ETFs are expected to commence trading on the New York Stock Exchange in the second quarter of 2010.  We are also in discussions with established investment managers that represent what we believe is a diversified series of investment strategies and assets classes such that, if we are able to create and market ETFs with them, it will enable us to offer a diversified selection of actively managed investment products to select from.

Weston Capital Management, LLC

Weston Capital’s Business
 
Weston Capital and its affiliates (including investment advisers registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission) are an alternative investment group founded in 1993.  With offices in West Palm Beach, New York and London, Weston Capital and its affiliates currently employ more than 25 professionals worldwide managing approximately $1 billion across more than 15 private investment funds.  It has three lines of business: (i) it originates and markets fund of funds; (ii) it originates and markets single-manager hedge funds; and (iii) it raises capital to seed new hedge funds.
 
Weston Capital primarily manages and advises funds of hedge funds with a broad range of strategies, and fund platforms that “seed” other funds or fund managers, including SEC-registered investment advisers.  The funds of hedge funds managed by Weston Capital generally seek capital appreciation by investing in other hedge funds and accounts selected by Weston Capital.  The fund platforms managed by Weston Capital that seed other funds or fund managers generally seek additional returns by sharing in the management and performance compensation earned by the seeded managers from their own management businesses and by sharing in any sale proceeds of seeded managers, or by receiving comparable returns from investments in funds managed by seeded managers.  The primary sources of Weston Capital’s revenue are (i) management fees, generally calculated as a percentage of its managed funds’ net asset values, and (ii) performance-based compensation, generally based on the realized and unrealized profits earned by its managed funds.
 
 
3

 
 
Management believes with Weston Capital’s operations when aligned with our majority interest in AdvisorShares, we may be able to accelerate increases of assets under management since we now has the ability to seed, originate and distribute hedge funds as well as seed, originate, develop and distribute actively traded ETFs to institutional and retail investors. 
 
In 2010, Weston Capital and Harcourt AG formed a strategic alliance for investment manager identification and fund seeding. Harcourt, a $4.5 billion alternative investments manager owned by Vontobel Group, the $70 billion Swiss banking group, is a leading global advisor of alternative investments for institutional investors. Under the Harcourt strategic alliance, Weston Capital and Harcourt will seed and develop new hedge fund businesses via Weston Capital’s incubation platform. The alliance combines Weston Capital’s extensive experience in early stage hedge fund investing and marketing with Harcourt’s proven investment expertise in global manager selection, due diligence and risk management.

Since January 2004, Weston Capital’s hedge fund seeding platform (via the Weston Capital-Atlas Partners Fund and the Weston Capital Partners Fund II) has provided sponsor capital for 13 emerging hedge fund managers. Weston Capital intends to raise $250 million for its third incubation fund, Partners III, which will seed both hedge funds and actively managed ETFs, with Harcourt providing investment infrastructure and risk management.

Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc.
 
On October 14, 2009, the Company entered into an agreement with the stockholders of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., a Delaware corporation, d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy” (“Whyte Lyon”) to acquire 100% of the capital stock of such corporation in exchange for 500,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, which the parties valued at $2.00 per share.  Closing of the acquisition of the shares of Whyte Lyon occurred on November 2, 2009 following consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement.  However, for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments in connection with the Whyte Lyon acquisition and the Vensure investment were deemed to have occurred effective on September 29, 2009.  Upon completion of the Company’s acquisition of Whyte Lyon, its principal stockholder, Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Company.
 
Whyte Lyon is a development stage online provider of financial literacy video content delivered over the Internet. Sometimes referred to as distance learning, such remote educational content is designed to assist on-line students to:

·
develop the necessary skills to understand financial transactions and financial markets;
·
develop money management skills to help them manage their income and wealth; and
·
reach particular goals, including homeownership, debt reconciliation, or improved credit reports.

Whyte Lyon seeks to fill a perceived need for basic understanding of the complex financial issues that drive today’s economy. The company delivers on-line educational content to designated end users for distribution and online streaming.  Its content, to be designated and branded as “The Institute of Modern Economy” will consist of seven to twelve minute educational course segments on personal finance management, financial products and other related financial topics.  Under the trademarked name "Institute of Modern Economy" (“IOME”), educational videos are shot, animated and produced for existing clientele. Customers may either customize specific subject matter for development, or purchase existing material from the IOME catalog.

Since November 2009, Whyte Lyon has produced a total of seven videos for its short lecture series. Titles include: "Understanding Debt", "The Recession", "The Ascent of Money", "Your Taxes", "Exchange Traded Funds", "The Credit Card Act", "Business Structures: Corporations".
 
 
4

 
 
Whyte Lyon management seeks to expand their educational platform to include conventional (classroom setting) seminars and workshops, to be taught by Yale alumni-professor Joseph Bianco at The Yale Club, located in New York City. In addition, the course modules will reach its broader audience through the utilization of online educational learning, as the lectured content will be made available through the company’s website (www.iomeusa.com). Courses and lectures will draw from a curriculum entitled “Financial Literacy 101”, developed by Joseph Bianco during his tenure as Yale Law professor. Although not intended to replace the need for outside professional advisors, the course segments are intended to enable the average consumer who takes the on-line or live course to:

·
better understand the financial world and his or her options;
·
take the initiative for their own financial goals, and
·
make better and more efficient use of outside professionals.
 
Potential revenue sources are: (i) tuition for on-line and live classroom sessions, (ii) fees for passive viewing of archive material (similar to the Learning Annex); (iii) lead generation and referral income from affiliated websites and professionals; (iv) bulk corporate or school sales through distributors; and (v) sale of ancillary materials.
 
Whyte Lyon believes that, faced with retraining 50 million American workers, corporate America is using distance learning, both internally and externally, for all aspects of training. Whyte Lyon believes that many major corporations save millions of dollars each year using distance learning to train employees more effectively and more efficiently than with conventional methods. Whyte Lyon believes that adult learners are seeking accessible methods to gain the necessary skills needed to understand financial transactions and financial markets, to develop money management skills to help them manage their income and wealth, and to help them reach particular goals, including homeownership, debt reconciliation, and improved credit reports.
 
Whyte Lyon believes that there is an increasing demand across every demographic and geographic location for courses in essential finance principles, such as investments, banking and money systems, portfolio management, international finance, interest rates in various markets, venture capital and basic economics of business. Whyte Lyon believes that there is a widely held belief that more educated consumers would be less likely to voluntarily enter into an improvident contract, and that financial literacy education will help alleviate the current need to develop and enforce regulations that would curtail bad market practices.
 
Investment in Vensure Employer Services, Inc.

Vensure Employer Services, Inc., a professional employer organization, or PEO, is located in Mesa, Arizona.  Vensure provides comprehensive services for its clients in the area of personnel management, which encompasses a broad range of human resource functions, consisting of payroll and benefits administration, health and workers’ compensation insurance programs, personnel records management, employer liability management, and workplace safety and loss control, including a retirement services product line that offers a variety of options to clients like 401(k) plans, profit sharing, and money purchase plans. Vensure provides these services to small to medium-sized businesses. Vensure believes its services enable small and medium-sized businesses to cost-effectively manage and enhance the employment relationship by: (i) controlling the risks and costs associated with workers' compensation, workplace safety and employee-related litigation; (ii) providing employees with high quality health care coverage and related benefits; (iii) managing the increasingly complex legal and regulatory environment affecting employment; and (iv) achieving scale advantages typically available to larger organizations. By entering into a co-employment contract with its clients, Vensure assumes specific employer responsibilities and becomes a statutory employer for purposes of certain aspects of tax and employment law.

Vensure believes that businesses today seek assistance with managing increasingly complex employee related matters such as health benefits, workers' compensation claims, payroll, payroll tax compliance, and unemployment insurance claims. Such businesses contract with Vensure to assume these responsibilities and provide expertise in human resources management. This allows Vensure’s clients to concentrate on the operational and revenue-producing side of its operations.
 
The PEO relationship involves a contractual allocation and sharing of employer responsibilities between the PEO and the client, which is known as “co-employment”.  As a co-employer with its client companies, Vensure contractually assumes substantial employer rights, responsibilities, and risks through the establishment and maintenance of an employer relationship with the workers assigned to its clients. Specifically, Vensure establishes a contractual relationship with its clients whereby Vensure:

·
co-employs workers at client locations, and thereby assumes responsibility as an employer for specified purposes of the workers assigned to the client locations;
·
reserves a right of direction and control of the employees;
·
shares or allocates with the client employer responsibilities in a manner consistent with maintaining the client's responsibility for its products or services;
·
pays wages and employment taxes of the employee out of its own accounts;
·
reports, collects and deposits employment taxes with state and federal authorities;
·
establishes and maintains an employment relationship with its employees that is intended to be long term and not temporary; and
·
retains a right to hire, reassign and fire employees.
 
 
5

 
 
The client company provides Vensure’s worksite employees with the tools, instruments, and workplace. Vensure may assist in ensuring that worksite employees are provided with a worksite that is safe, conducive to productivity and operated in compliance with employment laws and regulations. When evaluating the employer role of either Vensure or the client, the facts and circumstances of each employer obligation are examined separately, because neither party alone is responsible for performing all of the obligations of employment. Each party will be solely responsible for certain obligations of employment, while both parties will share responsibility for other obligations. When the facts and circumstances of a PEO arrangement are examined appropriately, both Vensure and the client will be found to be an employer for some purposes, but neither party will be found to be "the" employer for all purposes.

Vensure manages its employment liability exposure by monitoring and requiring compliance with employment laws, developing policies and procedures that apply to worksite employees, supervising and disciplining worksite employees, exercising discretion related to hiring new employees, and ultimately terminating worksite employees who do not comply with requirements established by Vensure. In addition, Vensure uses a large deductible workers’ compensation policy, which generates a significant percentage of its gross profits. By undertaking this risk, Vensure is able to participate in the underwriting income typically reserved for the insurance carrier.
 
According to information furnished by Vensure, as of February 2010, Vensure directly employed or acted as co-employer for approximately 5,400 employees provided to approximately 281 business clients, up from approximately 4,000 employees and 269 clients as of September 25, 2009.
 
Vensure’s target clients are small and medium sized businesses in the United States with fewer than 100 employees.  Vensure advises that there are approximately 9.4 million employers in the geographic markets that it is capable of servicing, of which more than 99% have fewer than 100 employees.  Based on publicly available industry data, Vensure estimates that all independent PEOs and other payroll processors serve approximately 15% of the potential businesses in this market, with much of the un-penetrated market composed of businesses with ten or fewer employees.

We believe that Vensure’s target market is large and therefore provides a significant potential growth opportunity for Fund.com.

    ·   
The PEO industry generates approximately $51 billion in gross revenues annually;
    ·
The Harvard Business Review recognized the PEO industry "the fastest growing business service in the United States during the 1990s;
    ·   
US Department of Labor Statistics predicts that by the year 2020, more than half of American employees will be employed by Professional Employer Organizations (PEO);
    ·
The US Small Business Administration (SBA) found the average annual cost of regulation, paperwork and tax compliance for companies with fewer than 500 employees is about $5,000 per employee. For companies with more than 500 employees, the cost is about $3,400 an employee;
    ·   
According to the Office of the Chief Counsel for Advocacy of the U.S. Small Business Administration, small businesses face an annual regulatory cost of $7,647 per employee, which is 45 percent higher than the regulatory cost facing large firms (defined as firms with 500 or more employees); and
    ·
An SBA study estimated that the average small business owner spends between 7% and 25% of his or her time handling employee-related paperwork.
 
Vensure also provides software development services primarily geared toward automating its clients’ business processes and integrating their systems with Vensure’s payroll and human resource management information system. In addition, Vensure seeks development projects unrelated to its PEO services where a specific industry may be well served by such software and where Vensure would gain a competitive advantage in attracting PEO clients by offering Vensure’s software in a comprehensive business solution package.

Vensure owns a general insurance agency, Vensurance, LLC, which offers a variety of property and casualty as well as life and health insurance products for businesses and associations. Vensurance was started to allow Vensure to capture some of the commission revenue resulting from its own insurance programs as well as those insurance products purchased by its clients which are not provided through the PEO service offering. In addition, Vensurance provides Vensure with PEO opportunities as the company markets its insurance services to small businesses throughout many States.
 
 
6

 
 
As a result of our investment in Vensure, we will be able to offer our products to the employees of Vensure, including The Institute of Modern Economy online educational courses, to assist them in managing their personal finances and retirement goals and access other investment products we may be able to provide. The National Council on Economic Education reported that 33% of employees increased their contributions to their retirement savings plan after having received financial education.   In addition, subject to compliance with all federal and state securities and tax laws and regulation, we intend to offer our AdvisorShares ETF products to Vensure employees for their individual retirement savings plans.

Our Business Strategy
 
We believe that by creating, originating and distributing a variety of investment fund products through a powerful media network, we can uniquely position ourselves at the center of the pooled investment solutions arena for both the mass and institutional investor markets.  Our strategy is to
 
    ·   
Originate and distribute investment solutions that satisfy the risk management goals of both institutional and retail investors
    ·
Build a media network addressing the investment needs of the mass and institutional markets; and
    ·   
Grow through strategic acquisitions
 
Our market audience is large. According to the Investment Company Institute, in 2009, an annual ICI survey of mutual fund ownership found that 50.4 million, or 43.0%, of households in the United States owned mutual funds.  In addition, mutual fund–owning households often hold more than one mutual fund. In 2009, the median number of mutual funds owned by shareholder households was four. Among these households, 42% owned three or fewer funds, and 58% owned four or more, with 14% reporting they held 11 or more funds. Reflecting an uncertainty amongst individuals about how investment savings should be allocated, we believe that this represents a large market opportunity for Fund.com.
 
Through our AdvisorShares acquisition, we believe that we will be able to benefit in the growth of the ETF market sector, which in 2009 were at record levels in the United States.  According to Blackrock Research:

    ·   
At the end of 2009, the United States ETF industry had 772 ETFs with assets of $705.5 billion from 28 providers on two exchanges;
    ·
In the United States, net sales of mutual funds (excluding ETFs) were minus $131.5 billion, while net sales of ETFs domiciled in the United States were positive $64.0 billion during the first 9 months of 2009 according to Strategic Insight.
    ·
Additionally, there were 142 other ETPs (Exchange Traded Products) with assets of $88.1 billion from 17 providers on one exchange.
    ·
Combined, there were 914 products with assets of $793.6 billion from 41 providers on two exchanges in the United States.
 
About Exchange Traded Funds
 
An exchange-traded fund (or ETF) is an investment vehicle traded on stock exchanges, much like stocks. An ETF holds assets such as stocks or bonds and trades at approximately the same price as the net asset value of its underlying assets over the course of the trading day. Most ETFs track an index, such as the S&P 500 or MSCI EAFE. ETFs may be attractive as investments because of their low costs, tax efficiency, and stock-like features.
 
ETFs offer public investors an undivided interest in a pool of securities and other assets and thus are similar in many ways to traditional mutual funds, except that shares in an ETF can be bought and sold throughout the day like stocks on a securities exchange through a broker-dealer. Unlike traditional mutual funds, ETFs do not sell or redeem their individual shares at net asset value, or NAV. Instead, financial institutions purchase and redeem ETF shares directly from the ETF, but only in large blocks, varying in size by ETF from 25,000 to 200,000 shares, called "creation units." Purchases and redemptions of the creation units generally are in kind, with the institutional investor contributing or receiving a basket of securities of the same type and proportion held by the ETF, although some ETFs may require or permit a purchasing or redeeming shareholder to substitute cash for some or all of the securities in the basket of assets.
 
 
7

 
 
An “actively managed” ETF is not an index fund that seeks to replicate the performance of a specified index.  An actively managed ETF uses an active investment strategy to meet its investment objectives. As a result, each of the investment sub-advisors to AdvisorShares ETFs has discretion on a daily basis to manage the fund’s portfolio in accordance with its stated investment objectives.
 
Only so-called “authorized participants” (typically, large institutional investors) actually obtain or redeem shares of an ETF directly from the fund manager, and then only in “creation units”, large blocks of tens of thousands of ETF shares that can be exchanged in-kind with baskets of the underlying securities. Authorized participants may hold the ETF shares or they may act as market makers on the open market, using their ability to exchange creation units with their underlying securities to provide liquidity of the ETF shares and help ensure that their intraday market price approximates the net asset value of the underlying assets. Other investors, such as individuals using a retail brokerage, trade ETF shares on this secondary market.
 
An ETF combines the valuation feature of a mutual fund or unit investment trust, which can be purchased or redeemed at the end of each trading day for its net asset value, with the tradability feature of a closed-end fund, which trades throughout the trading day at prices that may be more or less than its net asset value. Closed-end funds are not considered to be exchange-traded funds, even though they are funds and are traded on an exchange. ETFs have been available in the United States since 1993 and in Europe since 1999. ETFs traditionally have been index funds, but in 2008 the Securities and Exchange Commission began to authorize the creation of actively managed ETFs.
 
The ability to purchase and redeem creation units gives ETFs an arbitrage mechanism intended to minimize the potential deviation between the market price and the net asset value of ETF shares. Existing ETFs have transparent portfolios, so institutional investors will know exactly what portfolio assets they must assemble if they wish to purchase a creation unit, and the exchange disseminates the updated net asset value of the shares throughout the trading day, typically at 15-second intervals. If there is strong investor demand for an ETF, its share price will (temporarily) rise above its net asset value per share, giving arbitrageurs an incentive to purchase additional creation units from the ETF and sell the component ETF shares in the open market. The additional supply of ETF shares increases the ETF's market capitalization and reduces the market price per share, generally eliminating the premium over net asset value. A similar process applies when there is weak demand for an ETF and its shares trade at a discount from net asset value.
 
Under existing regulations, a new ETF must receive an order from the SEC giving it relief from provisions of the Investment Company Act of 1940 that would not otherwise allow the ETF structure. In 2008, however, the SEC proposed rules that would allow the creation of ETFs without the need for exemptive orders. Under the SEC proposal, an ETF would be defined as a registered open-end management investment company that:
 
    ·   
Issues (or redeems) creation units in exchange for the deposit (or delivery) of basket assets the current value of which is disseminated on a per share basis by a national securities exchange at regular intervals during the trading day;
    ·
Identifies itself as an ETF in any sales literature;
    ·   
Issues shares that are approved for listing and trading on a securities exchange;
    ·
Discloses each business day on its publicly available web site the prior business day's net asset value and closing market price of the fund's shares, and the premium or discount of the closing market price against the net asset value of the fund's shares as a percentage of net asset value; and
    ·   
Either is an index fund, or discloses each business day on its publicly available web site the identities and weighting of the component securities and other assets held by the fund.
 
The SEC rule proposal would allow ETFs either to be index funds or to be fully transparent actively managed funds. Historically, all ETFs in the United States have been index funds. In 2008, however, the SEC began issuing exemptive orders to fully transparent actively managed ETFs.  The SEC rule proposal indicates that the SEC is not suggesting that it will not consider future applications for exemptive orders for actively managed ETFs that do not satisfy the proposed rule's transparency requirements.
 
Some ETFs invest primarily in commodities or commodity-based instruments, such as crude oil and precious metals. Although these commodity ETFs are similar in practice to ETFs that invest in securities, they are not "investment companies" under the Investment Company Act of 1940.
 
 
8

 
 
Among the advantages of ETFs are the following:
 
    ·   
Lower costs - ETFs generally have lower costs than other investment products because most ETFs are not actively managed and because ETFs are insulated from the costs of having to buy and sell securities to accommodate shareholder purchases and redemptions. ETFs typically have lower marketing, distribution and accounting expenses, and most ETFs do not have 12b-1 fees.
    ·
Buying and selling flexibility - ETFs can be bought and sold at current market prices at any time during the trading day, unlike mutual funds and unit investment trusts, which can only be traded at the end of the trading day. As publicly traded securities, their shares can be purchased on margin and sold short, enabling the use of hedging strategies, and traded using stop orders and limit orders, which allow investors to specify the price points at which they are willing to trade.
    ·
Tax efficiency - ETFs generally generate relatively low capital gains, because they typically have low turnover of their portfolio securities. While this is an advantage they share with other index funds, their tax efficiency is further enhanced because they do not have to sell securities to meet investor redemptions.
    ·
Market exposure and diversification - ETFs provide an economical way to rebalance portfolio allocations and to "equitize" cash by investing it quickly. An index ETF inherently provides diversification across an entire index. ETFs offer exposure to a diverse variety of markets, including broad-based indexes, broad-based international and country-specific indexes, industry sector-specific indexes, bond indexes, and commodities.
    ·
Transparency - ETFs, whether index funds or actively managed, have transparent portfolios and are priced at frequent intervals throughout the trading day.
 
The Fund.com Website
 
The initial development of the website was completed in February, 2009.  We intend to continually update the site with new content and features.  The initial visitation to the site is in accordance with expectations. In March 2010, we entered into a strategic alliance with Transparensee Systems, Inc., to develop a next generation search engine for the www.fund.com website to help investors find their best choices among mutual funds and ETFs.  It is anticipated that investors will be able to search the database for mutual funds and ETFs in real time to find specific funds that meet their criteria.  Transparensee has developed search engines using this advanced technology for four years. The new search engine is expected to be launched during the third quarter of 2010. There will be future modifications and enhancements to the site that will more prominently profile Fund.com’s various affiliate businesses.

Marketing, Content and Distribution
 
We continue to consider a variety of sales and marketing initiatives to increase traffic to www.fund.com, license our content, expose our brands and build our customer databases. We believe that these initiatives may include promoting our services using online and email marketing, establishing content syndication and subscription distribution relationships with leading companies with whom we have had discussions, including with EQUITIES Magazine, and engaging in an ongoing public awareness campaign.
 
Marketing costs will be comprised of expenses associated with expanding brand awareness of our products and services to consumers and may include key word campaigns on internet search engines, print and internet advertising, marketing and promotion costs.
 
Competitive Business Conditions and Competitive Position

Exchange Traded Funds Competition
 
The “Active ETF” market is in early stage development.  As of February 28, 2010, there were approximately 24 active ETFs trading in the market, including currency ETFs, with assets under management of approximately $1.4 Billion. Currency ETFs represent the majority of these assets.  There are several companies that have applied for an SEC exemptive order to enter the Active ETF market.
 
 
9

 
 
Investment Management Competition
 
The fund of hedge funds and manager seeding business is intensely competitive.  Weston Capital’s investment management business competes with a number of fund-of-fund managers and other private investment fund managers and financial institutions.
 
Competition is based on a variety of factors, including the ability to find high-performing underlying funds in which to invest and managers to seed, overall investment performance, the quality of service provided to clients, investor liquidity and willingness to invest and the ability to negotiate favorable investment terms (including fees).  Weston Capital also may face a competitive disadvantage in identifying attractive investment opportunities with underlying funds and/or managers because, among other things, its competitors may have a lower cost of capital and access to funding sources that are not available to Weston Capital and may have better expertise or be regarded as having better expertise than Weston Capital in selecting underlying funds in which to invest.  Additionally, in respect of Weston Capital’s manager seeding business, Weston Capital’s competitors may secure investment opportunities that Weston Capital is pursuing through their greater brand name recognition and by offering to underlying funds and/or managers a higher level of capital, greater access to capital introductions from other investors and additional operational and administrative services.
 
Some of Weston’s competitors may have higher risk tolerances, different risk assessments or lower return thresholds, which could allow them to consider a wider variety of investments in underlying private investment funds and to bid more aggressively than Weston Capital for investments that Weston Capital wants to make.  In addition, when raising new funds or making further investments in existing funds, Weston Capital negotiates terms for such investments with existing and potential investors. The outcome of such negotiations could result in Weston Capital’s agreement to terms that are materially less favorable to Weston Capital than for funds managed by its competitors. Such terms could restrict Weston Capital’s ability to raise funds with investment objectives or strategies that compete with existing funds, add additional expenses and obligations for Weston Capital in managing its funds or increase its potential liabilities, all of which could ultimately reduce Weston Capital’s revenues.  Moreover, even once an investment is made, managers may limit the amount of additional capital that they will accept from Weston Capital and continued sales of shares in such funds to other investors, including Weston Capital’s competitors, could dilute the indirect participation of Weston Capital’s funds.

Professional Employer Organization Business Competition
 
Vensure faces PEO competition from new entrants to the field, including other PEO’s, payroll processing companies and insurance companies. Certain PEO companies that periodically compete with us in the same markets have greater financial and marketing resources than we do, such as Barrett Business Services, Inc., Diversified Human Resources, Inc., Administaff, Inc. and Paychex, Inc., among others. Competition in the PEO industry is based largely on price, although service and quality can also provide competitive advantages. A significant limiting factor to the growth of the PEO industry is the perception of potential clients that they have the capacity to handle human resource issues internally. We believe that Vensure’s past growth in fee revenues is attributable to its ability to provide small and medium-sized companies with the opportunity to reduce workers’ compensation costs while reducing their overall personnel administration costs. Vensure’s competitive advantage may be adversely affected by a substantial increase in the costs of maintaining our workers’ compensation program, or changes in the regulatory environment. A general market decrease in the level of workers’ compensation insurance premiums likely would decrease demand for PEO services among some prospective client companies.
 
Internet Business Competition
 
We are in competition with both traditional and online companies engaged in the creation and distribution of business, investment, investment ratings content and index licensing. We have several direct on-line competitors with long operating histories and well established brands such as Thestreet.com, The Wall Street Journal Online (www.wsj.com), Forbes.com, SmartMoney.com, MarketWatch.com, The Motley Fool and CNBC.com, as well as financial portals such as Yahoo! Finance and Google Finance. Our investment index competitors include Morningstar, Dow Jones, Standard & Poor’s, The Financial Times and MSCI Barra, a public company majority owned by Morgan Stanley.
 
Many of our competitors are established and have far greater financial resources, more experience and larger staffs than do we.  Additionally, many have proven operating histories, which we lack.  We expect to face strong competition from both well-established companies and small independent companies.  Significant competitive factors in our market include: the quality, originality, timeliness, insightfulness and trustworthiness of our content, our ability to introduce products and services that keep pace with new investing trends, the ease of use of services developed and the effectiveness of our sales and marketing efforts.
 
 
10

 
 
Subsidiaries
 
We have four wholly owned subsidiaries: (i) Fund.com Technologies, Inc., (ii) Fund.com Managed Products, Inc., with its wholly owned subsidiary Fund.com Capital, Inc., (iii) Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., and (iv) Weston Capital Management, LLC.  We also have a 60% interest in AdvisorShares Investments LLC.
 
Employees
 
We currently have approximately 30 employees amongst Fund.com and its affiliated companies. We consider our relations with these employees to be good. We have never had a work stoppage, and none of our employees is represented by collective bargaining agreements. We believe that our future success will depend in part on our ability to attract, integrate, retain and motivate highly qualified personnel and upon the continued service of our senior management and key technical personnel. None of our key personnel is bound by employment agreements that prohibit them from ending their employment at any time. Competition for qualified personnel in our industry and geographical location is intense. We cannot provide assurance that we will be successful in attracting, integrating, retaining and motivating a sufficient number of qualified employees to conduct our business in the future.
 
Intellectual Property
 
We will rely on a combination of trademark, copyright and trade secret and laws in the United States and abroad as well as contractual provisions to protect our proprietary technology. We currently have trademarks registered in the United States for certain domain addresses which we own and intend to file for trademarks in the future for our assets. We will rely on contractual provisions and copyright laws to protect source and the content of our intellectual property.
 
Governmental Regulation

Exchange Traded Fund Regulation
 
Our majority owned subsidiary, AdvisorShares, is an originator and distributor of actively managed exchange traded funds and must responsibly react and comply with various regulations and compliance guidelines set forth by the Securities and Exchange Commission, FINRA, the New York Stock Exchange and all other regulatory organizations that set and supervise the origination and distribution of these products.

Investment Management Regulation
 
Our wholly-owned subsidiary, Weston Capital, is a manager of institutional alternative investment solutions.   As a result of highly-publicized financial scandals in recent years, investors, regulators and the general public exhibited concerns over the integrity of both the U.S. financial markets and the regulatory oversight of these markets. As a result, the business environment in which we operate is subject to heightened regulation. With respect to alternative investment management funds, in recent years, there has been debate in both U.S. and foreign governments about new rules or regulations, including increased oversight or taxation. As calls for additional regulation have increased, there may be a related increase in regulatory investigations of the trading and other investment activities of alternative investment funds, including our private investment funds. Such investigations may impose additional expenses on us, may require the attention of senior management and may result in fines if any of our private investment funds are deemed to have violated any regulations.

Professional Employer Organization Business Regulation

We believe that Vensure is an employer of employees provided to our PEO clients on a co-employment basis under the various laws and regulations of the Internal Revenue Service and the U.S. Department of Labor.  Vensure’s PEO and staffing businesses are heavily regulated in most jurisdictions in which they operate.  In most States, Vensure’s industry is regulated by the applicable State Department of Insurance. Other States regulate the PEO industry through the equivalent of the Corporation Commission.
 
Future growth in Vensure’s operations depends, in part, on the ability to offer services to prospective clients in new States, which may subject Vensure to different regulatory requirements and standards. In order to operate effectively in a new State, a PEO must obtain all necessary regulatory approvals, adapt procedures to the applicable State’s regulatory requirements and modify service offerings to adapt to local market conditions.
 
 
11

 
 
Corporate human resource operations are subject to a broad range of complex and evolving laws and regulations, including those applicable to payroll practices, benefits administration, employment practices and privacy. Because Vensure’s clients have employees in many states throughout the United States, they must perform services in compliance with the legal and regulatory requirements of multiple jurisdictions.

Internet Business Regulation
 
We participate as a information services company and an online advertising business The growth and development of the market for internet commerce and communications has prompted both federal and state laws and regulations concerning the collection and use of personally identifiable information (including consumer credit and financial information under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act), consumer protection, the content of online publications, the taxation of online transactions and the transmission of unsolicited commercial email, popularly known as “spam.” More laws and regulations are under consideration by various governments, agencies and industry self-regulatory groups. We believe that our practices are in compliance with applicable laws.
 
Our activities may include, among other things, the offering of stand-alone services providing fund recommendations and analysis to subscribers, in contrast to providing such information as part of a larger online financial publication of more general and regular circulation. As a result, we may in the future be required to register with the Securities and Exchange Commission as an investment advisor under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940. Investment advisors are subject to Securities and Exchange Commission regulations covering all aspects of the operation of their business, including, among others:
 
·
advertising,
·
record-keeping,
·
conduct of directors, officers and employees, and
·
supervision of advisory activities.
 
Securities Purchase Agreement with National Holdings Corporation
 
On April 8, 2009, the Company entered into a definitive Securities Purchase Agreement (the “Purchase Agreement”), with National Holdings Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“NHC”) whereby the Company agreed to provide a minimum $5 million financing to NHC (the “Financing”) exchange for an aggregate of 5,000 shares of NHC to be created Series C Convertible Preferred Stock, par value $0.01 per share at a purchase price of $1,000.00 per share, and warrants, exercisable at any time, and entitling the holder to purchase up to an aggregate of 25,333,333 shares of common stock of NHC (on an as-exercised basis) with an exercise price of $0.75 per share. The Company provided NHC with an initial investment tranche of $500,000, as evidenced by NHC’s limited recourse promissory note, dated April 8, 2009, which note would have automatically converted into shares of Series C Preferred Stock upon consummation of the Financing or, if the Company was unable to close the balance of the Financing by April 30, 2009, into 666,666 shares of NHC common stock also based on a $0.75 per common share price. We borrowed the $500,000 initial tranche from Global Asset Fund Limited, (“GAF”), through a loan, which is secured by a pledge of NHC’s limited recourse note and all of our rights and interests in the Purchase Agreement. On May 15, 2009, our $500,000 NHC limited recourse note was converted into 666,666 shares of NHC common stock, which are pledged as collateral to secure our $500,000 loan from GAF. At September 30, 2009, the $500,000 note had not been repaid.  On November 3, 2009, GAF and the Company settled the $500,000 obligation by transferring the pledged stock to GAF.
 
The Company was unable to obtain the requisite funding to make the $5.0 million investment in NHC and consummate the Financing.  Accordingly, the Purchase Agreement has been terminated. 
 
Our History and the Reverse Merger
 
We were originally incorporated as Eastern Service Holdings, Inc. under the laws of the State of Delaware on November 5, 2004, and commenced operations for the purposes of evaluating, structuring and completing a merger with Eastern Services Group, Inc. On November 9, 2004, Eastern Service Holdings, Inc. obtained all of the outstanding stock of Eastern Services Group, Inc. Eastern Services Group, Inc., was established in the State of Nevada in February 1998 and formerly provided state and local tax consultation and analysis to casinos in the Las Vegas metropolitan area.  On December 21, 2007, all of the issued and outstanding shares of common stock of Eastern Services Group, Inc. were sold to Richard S. Carrigan in exchange for approximately $105,000 in accrued salary. Following the sale, Eastern Services Holdings, Inc had no debts, liabilities or obligations.
 
 
12

 
 
On January 15, 2008, our predecessor, also known as Fund.com Inc. (‘Old Fund”), merged (the “Merger”) with and into Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. (“Eastern”) pursuant to an Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of January 15, 2008 (the "Agreement"). In connection with the Merger, Eastern Services Holdings, Inc., as the surviving corporation of the Merger (the “Surviving Corporation”) changed its name to Fund.com Inc. Pursuant to the Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.00001 per share of Old Fund (“Old Fund Common Stock”) was converted into the right to receive 0.1278 validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A Common Stock of our Company, as the Surviving Corporation; provided, that, if a holder of Old Fund Common Stock also held Series A Preferred Stock, par value $.001 per share, of Old Fund (“Old Fund Preferred Stock”) then each share of Old Fund Common Stock held by such holder was converted into the right to receive 0.1278 validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class B Common Stock of the Surviving Corporation (and Old Fund Preferred Stock held by such holder was cancelled). Each share of common stock, $0.001 par value per share, of Eastern was converted into the right to receive one validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable share of Class A Common Stock of the Surviving Corporation. As a result, at closing of the Merger, we issued 37,112,345 shares of our Class A Common Stock and 6,387,665 shares of our Class B Common Stock to former shareholders of Old Fund, representing 87% of our outstanding Class A Common Stock and 100% of our Class B Common Stock following the Merger.

Each share of Class A Common stock has one (1) vote per share.  Each share of Class B Common Stock has ten (10) votes per share.  The holders of Class B Common Stock shall have the right to convert each share of Class B Common Stock into ten shares of Class A Common Stock (adjusted to reflect subsequent stock splits, combinations, stock dividends and recapitalizations).
 
The merger consideration was determined as a result of arm’s-length negotiations between the parties. At the time of the closing of the Merger, as of January 15, 2008, Ahkee Rahman, the sole director, resigned from all offices held with Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. and from the position as the director.  Prior to the Merger, there were no material relationships between Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. and Fund.com or any of our respective affiliates, directors or officers.  Following the Merger, we succeeded to the business of Old Fund, as our sole line of business. 
 
The shares of our Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock issued to Old Fund’s shareholders as part of the merger were not registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. These shares may not be sold or offered for sale in the absence of an effective registration statement for the shares under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or an applicable exemption from the registration requirements. Certificates evidencing these shares of common stock contain a legend stating the same. No shares of the Surviving Corporation’s common stock issued to Old Fund’s shareholders were immediately eligible for sale in the public market without restriction pursuant to Rule 144.
 
Our subsidiary, Fund.com Capital Inc. (then known as Meade Capital, Inc.) was originally established by Meade Technologies, Inc., the Company’s predecessor, to invest in financial entities and structure unregistered financial products and instruments, including fund management companies, and structured products offered or managed by such entities. As a result, at the time of the merger with Meade Technologies in January 2008, the Company believed that the purchase of its $20.0 million certificate of deposit investment would provide the Company with a material asset base, would serve as the basis for unregistered structured products and would provide capital for one or more potential acquisitions within its then business model as set forth in its business plan disclosed in a Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on January 17, 2008.  However, in view of the Company’s need for additional working capital, its decision to abandon the issuance of unregistered structured products in favor of pursuing exclusively investment products registered under the Securities Act and the right of Global Bank of Commerce to exchange and swap the three year certificate of deposit for a long-term annuity instrument that would not provide the Company with liquidity, our management determined that it would need to seek additional financing for the Company in order to support our other strategic initiatives, and could no longer place undue reliance on the investment in the certificate of deposit.

Under the terms of the Vensure Purchase Agreement (as described herein), we agreed to sell and assign to Vensure, our right to receive payments under the original $20.0 million certificate of deposit issued in November 2007 by Global Bank of Commerce in exchange for consideration consisting of (a) 218,883.33 shares of Series A participating convertible preferred stock of Vensure, and (b) a seven year content agreement among Vensure, Vensure Retirement Administration, Inc., a whole owned subsidiary of Vensure, our company and Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc. In October 2009, prior to the closing of the Vensure transaction, Global Bank of Commerce advised the Company of its intention to exercise its contractual rights to exchange the Certificate of Deposit for a 10 year 5.0% annuity contract issued by a third party.  We notified Vensure of the banks election (which was subsequently confirmed in writing), and on November 2, 2009 Vensure agreed to accept such annuity contract in lieu of the certificate of deposit.
 
 
13

 
 
Reports to Security Holders
 
The Company is a reporting company and files annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC.  For further information with respect to the Company, you may read and copy its reports, proxy statements and other information, at the SEC public reference rooms at 100 F. Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549.  You can request copies of these documents by writing to the SEC and paying a fee for the copying cost.  Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for more information about the operation of the public reference rooms.  The Company’s SEC filings are also available at the SEC’s web site at http://www.sec.gov.
 
 
 
14

 
 

An investment in our common stock is risky. You should carefully consider the following risks, as well as the other information contained in this Form 10-K, before investing. If any of the following risks actually occurs, our business, business prospects, financial condition, cash flow and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected. In this case, the trading price of our common stock could decline, and you might lose part or all of your investment.  We may amend or supplement the risk factors described below from time to time by other reports we file with the SEC in the future.

Risks Relating to Our Business and Industry
 
Although we believe our status has changed as a result of our acquisition of Weston Capital on March 29, 2010, as of December 31, 2009 we were still in the stage of development and have earned limited revenue to date.
 
Although we believe our status has changed as a result of our acquisition of Weston Capital on March 29, 2010, as of December 31, 2009 we were still a development-stage company. We have earned limited revenues to date and have supported our operations primarily through private equity investment. Our operations are subject to all of the risks inherent in the establishment of a new business enterprise. Our likelihood of success must be considered in light of the problems, expenses and delays frequently encountered in connection with a new business and the development of new products and new technology.
 
Excluding our Weston Capital subsidiary, we have a limited operating history, which limits the information available to you to evaluate our business, and have a history of operating losses and uncertain future profitability.
 
On January 15, 2008, we completed the Merger.  Since that time, operating and development expenses have been funded by cash on hand at January 15, 2008, private placements of equity sales and notes from our primary lender.   We will require additional sources of capital to fund operating expenses until such time that the Company becomes profitable.  If we are unable to secure additional external financing on a timely basis, we will not have sufficient cash to fund our working capital and capital expenditure requirements and we will be forced to cease operations. In such event, the shares of our common stock may cease to have any value.  There is limited operating and financial information to evaluate our historical performance and our future prospects. We face the risks and difficulties of a development-stage company including the uncertainties of market acceptance, competition, cost increases and delays in achieving business objectives. We cannot assure you that we will succeed in addressing any or all of these risks or that our efforts will generate significant revenue or achieve future profitability. Our failure to do so would have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.
    
We will require substantial additional financing.
 
We will need to raise substantial additional capital to fund operations and grow our business. Our existing capital and future revenues are not expected to be sufficient to support the expenses of our operations.  We will require significant capital in order to accomplish our short-term goals.  Specifically, on May 31, 2010, we will required to make a $2,450,000 installment payment on a note issued to the former owners of Weston Capital; failing which we could lose 50.9% of our equity interest in Weston Capital (thereby reducing our equity to 49.1%) and be unable to consolidate on our financial statements the revenues and income of that subsidiary.  Unless we receive additional external debt or equity financing, we will not have the working capital or liquidity to pay such note installment, when due.
 
For the past twelve months we have relied on loans and advances from IP Global Investors Ltd. (“IP Global”), a privately owned intellectual property finance company, to provide us with working capital to pay our operating expenses.  Effective as of August 28, 2009, the Company, IP Global and Equities Media Acquisition Corp. Inc., a principal stockholder of the Company, consummated transactions under a line of credit agreement pursuant to which IP Global provided the Company with a $2,500,000 line of credit facility which superseded and restated in its entirety a prior $1.343 million credit agreement with IP Global entered into as of May 1, 2009.  Fund.com is currently indebted to IP Global under the line of credit agreement in the aggregate amount of $2,030,750, plus accrued interest and fees, which loans are secured by liens on the Company’s domain name and substantially all of its other assets.  The Company’s revolving credit convertible note to IP Global (the “Note”) is due and payable on December 31, 2011.  However, to date, the Company has been unable to pay accrued interest and fees to the lenders under the Loan Agreement.
 
If we are unable to raise additional funds when needed, we may be unable to continue operating, fund our development and expansion, pursue more aggressive marketing programs, successfully promote our brand name, develop or enhance our products and services, take advantage of business opportunities or respond to competitive pressures, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our business and the price of our stock.
 
We may not be able to obtain audited financial statements of Vensure Employer Services.  

We hold a minority equity interest in Vensure Employer Services, Inc.  It was our intention to include audited financial statements of Vensure in this Annual Report.  However, such audit is not yet available.  Although we intend to include such audited financial statements in an amendment to this Annual Report, and have been advised by Vensure that they will shortly complete all procedures to enable our accountants to complete the audit of their financial statements, there is no assurance that such audit will, in fact, be completed in the near future.  Our inability to obtain audited financial statements of Vensure could adversely affect our future financial reporting and business plans.
 
 
15

 
 
Potential Conflicts Of Interest
 
From time to time, we have entered into transactions with persons and entities deemed to be our affiliates. Notwithstanding these potential conflicts of interest, our board of directors believes that the terms of these transactions will be at least as favorable to us as we could have been obtained from unaffiliated parties. There can be no assurance, however, that future conflicts of interest will not arise with respect thereto, or that if conflicts do arise, they will be resolved in a manner favorable to us.
 
The interests of our controlling shareholders could conflict with those of our other shareholders resulting in the approval of corporate actions that are not in your interests.
 
Our executive officers and principal shareholders collectively own or control approximately 3.6% of our Class A Common Stock (and approximately 2.0% of our voting power). In addition, Equities Media Acquisition Corp Inc., as holder of a majority of our outstanding Class B common stock, controls approximately 27.9% of our voting power. Class B holders therefore have significant influence over management and affairs and over all matters requiring stockholder approval, including the election of directors and significant corporate transactions, such as a merger or other sale of our company or its assets, for the foreseeable future. The Class B common shareholders are able to control the outcome of shareholder votes, including votes concerning: amendments to our certificate of incorporation and by-laws; the approval of significant corporate transactions like a merger or sale of our assets; and control the election of our board of directors. This controlling influence could have the effect of delaying or preventing a change in control, even if our other shareholders believe it is in their best interest.
  
We may be exposed to risks relating to our disclosure controls and our internal controls and may need to incur significant costs to comply with applicable requirements.  
 
Based on the evaluation done by our management at December 31, 2009, our disclosure controls were deemed ineffective, in that we could not assure that information required to be disclosed in our SEC reports is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and communicated to our management, so as to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosures.  Due to SEC comments we received concerning the late filing of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ending December 31, 2008, we re-examined our controls and procedures and management recognized the material weakness in our controls and procedures.  Generally, due to timing constraints related to the finalization of material agreements, we were unable to simultaneously close the books on a timely basis to generate all the necessary disclosure for inclusion in our 2008 Annual Report on Form 10-K, which caused us to be late in the filing of such report.  In addition, management concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls were ineffective due to the occurrence of issues that necessitated a restatement of interim period filings in 2009. In addition, we were unable to timely file this report.  Accordingly, through our examination, we also realized that our internal controls were ineffective.
 
No assurances can be given that we will be able to adequately remediate existing deficiencies in disclosure controls and not have deficiencies when we report on internal controls.  We may be required to expend additional resources to identify, assess and correct any additional weaknesses in disclosure or internal control and to otherwise comply with the internal controls rules under Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, when applicable.
 
If we are unable to establish appropriate internal financial reporting controls and procedures, it could cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations, result in the restatement of our financial statements, harm our operating results, subject us to regulatory scrutiny and sanction, cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information and have a negative effect on the market price for shares of our common stock.   
 
Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports and effectively prevent fraud. We maintain a system of internal control over financial reporting, which is defined as a process designed by, or under the supervision of, our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by our board of directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.
 
 
16

 
 
As a public company, we have significant additional requirements for enhanced financial reporting and internal controls. We are required to document and test our internal control procedures in order to satisfy the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, which requires annual management assessments of the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting and at some point, a report by our independent registered public accounting firm addressing these assessments. The process of designing and implementing effective internal controls is a continuous effort that requires us to anticipate and react to changes in our business and the economic and regulatory environments and to expend significant resources to maintain a system of internal controls that is adequate to satisfy our reporting obligations as a public company.
 
We cannot assure you that we will not, in the future, identify additional areas requiring improvement in our internal control over financial reporting. We cannot assure you that the measures we will take to remediate any areas in need of improvement will be successful or that we will implement and maintain adequate controls over our financial processes and reporting in the future as we continue our growth. If we are unable to establish appropriate internal financial reporting controls and procedures, it could cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations, result in the restatement of our financial statements, harm our operating results, subject us to regulatory scrutiny and sanction, cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information and have a negative effect on the market price for shares of our common stock.
  
We may issue additional  shares of preferred stock that could defer a change of control or dilute the interests of our common shareholders and our charter documents could defer a takeover effort, which could inhibit your ability to receive an acquisition premium for your shares or your ability to sell your shares of common stock.
 
Our certificate of incorporation permits our board of directors to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock without shareholder approval. As of the date hereof, we have issued an aggregate of 400,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock which are convertible into shares of our Class A Common Stock at a price of $1.50 per share. Shares of our preferred stock contain dividend, liquidation, conversion, voting or other rights which could adversely affect the rights of our common shareholders and which could also be utilized, under some circumstances, as a method of discouraging, delaying or preventing a change in control. Provisions of our certificate of incorporation, by-laws and Delaware law could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire us, even if many of our shareholders believe it is in their best interest. These provisions may decrease your ability to sell your shares of our common stock.
 
We depend on the services of our executive officers, and a loss of any of these individuals may harm our business.
 
Our performance is substantially dependent upon the performance of our executive officers and, to a lesser extent, certain other employees. The familiarity of these key employees to their respective industries makes these employees especially critical to our success. The loss of the services of any of our executive officers or key employees may harm our business and the cost to replace such individuals may put a strain on our limited resources.
 
Our future is dependent on the successful development of the Company’s technology, products and services.
 
We are in the initial stages of the development of www.fund.com and there is no assurance that when development is finished www.fund.com will perform as expected.  Our ability to continue operations will depend on the success of our development and integration of supplemental leading edge technology, and there is no assurance that the development and integration will be successful.
 
The market acceptance of a new investment content provider is uncertain.
 
Even if we are successful in the development of our technology, our success will depend upon the acceptance of our product by the general public. Insufficient market acceptance of our product would have a adverse effect on our Internet business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
We will need to expand our skilled personnel and retain those personnel that we do hire.
 
We will be required to hire and retain certain skilled employees at various levels of our operations as our affiliate companies’ assets under management reach certain growth levels.  The inability to hire needed employees on a timely basis and/or the inability to retain those that we do hire could have a material adverse effect on our ability to meet the schedule of our strategic plan.
 
 
17

 
 
We will need to successfully manage our growth, which we expect to be significant for the foreseeable future.
 
We plan on growing at a rapid pace, which will require, in part, the constant addition of certain new personnel in the finance and sales areas of our operations.  Even if we are successful in finding and hiring the appropriate personnel, there will be a significant strain placed on our managerial, operational, reporting and financial resources.  We have taken preliminary steps to put in place the necessary legal, accounting, human resource management and other relationships and tools to enable us to deal with this growth more efficiently.  However, there is no assurance that we will be able to successfully manage this rapid growth.
 
We must reach agreements with third parties to supply us with the hardware, software and infrastructure necessary to provide our services, and the loss of access to this hardware, software or infrastructure or any decline or obsolescence in functionality could cause our customers’ businesses to suffer, which, in turn, could decrease our revenues and increase our costs.
 
We have certain contemplated strategic vendor relationships that will be critical to our strategy.  We cannot assure you that these relationships can be obtained or maintained on terms favorable to us or at all.  Our success depends substantially on obtaining relationships with strategic partners. If we are unable to obtain or maintain our relationship with strategic partners, our business, prospects, financial condition and results of operations will be adversely affected.
 
We may be impacted by general economic conditions, which would negatively affect our business.
 
The global and U.S. economies are experiencing significantly reduced business activity as a result of, among other factors, disruptions in the financial system in the past year, and that trend appears to be continuing into 2010. We have observed dramatic declines in the asset levels of the investing public which includes the 401(K) participate market. The housing market during the past year, with falling home prices and increasing foreclosures and unemployment, have resulted in significant write-downs of asset values by financial institutions, including government-sponsored entities and major commercial and investment banks. These write-downs, initially of mortgage-backed securities but spreading to credit default swaps and other derivative securities have caused many financial institutions to seek additional capital, to merge with larger and stronger institutions and, in some cases, to fail.
 
            Current market turmoil and tightening of credit have led to an increased level of consumer and commercial delinquencies, lack of consumer confidence, increased market volatility and widespread reduction of business activity generally. The resulting economic pressure on consumers and lack of confidence in the financial markets has, in some cases, adversely affected the financial services industry.
 
The rates we charge for our product development services may decline over time, which would reduce our revenues and adversely affect our profitability.
 
As our business model gains acceptance and attracts the attention of competitors, we may experience pressure to decrease the fees for our services, which could adversely affect our revenues and gross margin.  If we are unable to sell our origination services at acceptable prices, or if we fail to offer additional services with sufficient profit margins, our revenue growth will slow and our business and financial results will suffer.
 
The market for web investment content is competitive.
 
Our proposed products and services will compete with products and services offered by numerous other entities.  Because we currently have no patented technology that would bar competitors from our market, and other barriers to entry in our market are relatively low, new competitors could enter our market at any time in the future.
 
We believe that our primary competitors include:
 
    ·
web sites offering investment information together with other related services, such as wsj.com, forbes.com, smartmoney.com, marketwatch.com, thestreet.com, cnbc.com, fool.com and Morningstar.com;
    ·
general purpose consumer web sites such as Google and Yahoo! that also offer financial investment content on their sites; and
    ·
traditional print media such as newspapers and magazines.
 
 
18

 
 
Many of our existing and potential competitors have longer operating histories in the internet market, greater name recognition, larger consumer bases and significantly greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do. Some of our competitors may also be able to provide customers with additional benefits at lower overall costs in an effort to increase market share. We cannot be sure that we will be able to match cost reductions by our competitors. Our competitors and other companies may form strategic relationships with each other to compete with us. These relationships may take the form of strategic investments, joint-marketing agreements, licenses or other contractual arrangements, which arrangements may increase our competitors’ ability to address customer needs with their product and service offerings. We believe that there is likely to be consolidation in our markets, which could lead to increased price competition and other forms of competition that could cause our business to suffer.
  
If we are unable to develop our web services and content, our business may suffer.
 
To remain competitive we must continue to enhance and improve the ease of use, responsiveness, functionality and features of our website. These efforts may require us to develop internally or to license increasingly complex technologies. In addition, many companies are continually introducing new internet-related products, services and technologies, which will require us to update or modify our technology. Developing and integrating new products, services or technologies into our website could be expensive and time consuming. Any new features, functions or services may not achieve market acceptance or enhance our brand loyalty. We have not completed development and testing of certain of our proposed web site features. If we fail to develop and introduce or acquire these features or other new features, functions or services effectively and on a timely basis, we may not continue to attract new users and may be unable to retain our existing users. Furthermore, we may not succeed in incorporating new internet technologies, or in order to do so, we may incur substantial expenses.
 
 Any factors that limit the amount advertisers are willing to spend on advertising on our web sites could have a material adverse effect on advertising revenue.
 
We expect to derive reasonable revenue in the foreseeable future through the sale of advertising space and hyperlinks on our web site. Any factors that limit the amount advertisers are willing to spend on advertising on our web site could have a material adverse effect on our business. These factors may include:
 
    ·   
a lack of standards for measuring web site traffic or effectiveness of web site advertising;
    ·   
a lack of established pricing models for internet advertising;
    ·   
the failure of traditional media advertisers to adopt internet advertising;
    ·   
the introduction of alternative advertising sources; and
    ·   
a lack of significant growth in web site traffic.
 
Continuing to demonstrate the effectiveness of advertising on our web site is critical to our ability to generate advertising revenue. Currently, there are no widely accepted standards to measure the effectiveness of internet advertising, and we cannot be certain that such standards will develop sufficiently to support our growth through internet advertising. A number of different pricing models are used to sell advertising on the internet. Pricing models are typically either CPM-based (cost per thousand impressions) or performance-based. We utilize the CPM-based model, which is based upon the number of advertisement impressions, and the performance-based, or cost-per-click (“CPC”), model, which generates revenue based on each individual click on a particular advertisement. We cannot predict which pricing model, if any, will emerge as the industry standard. Therefore, it is difficult for us to project our future advertising rates and revenues. For instance, banner advertising, which we anticipate to be one of our primary sources of online revenue, may not be an effective advertising method in the future. If we are unable to adapt to new forms of internet advertising and pricing models, our business could be adversely affected.
 
If we fail to detect click-through fraud or unscrupulous advertisers, we could lose the confidence of our advertisers, thereby causing our business to suffer.
 
We are exposed to the risk of fraudulent clicks on our ads by persons seeking to increase the advertising fees paid to us. Click-through fraud occurs when a person clicks on an ad displayed on our web site in order to generate revenue to us and to increase the cost for the advertiser. If we were unable to detect this fraudulent activity and find new evidence of past fraudulent clicks, we may have to issue refunds retroactively of amounts previously paid to us. In addition, if fraudulent clicks are not detected, the affected advertisers may experience a reduced return on their investment in our advertising programs because the fraudulent clicks would not lead to potential revenue for the advertisers.
 
 
19

 
 
We are also exposed to the risk that advertisers who advertise on our website will advertise interest rates on a variety of financial products that they do not intend to honor. Such “bait and switch” activity encourages consumers to contact fraudulent advertisers over legitimate advertisers because the fraudulent advertisers claim to offer a better interest rate.
 
Both “bait and switch” and click-through fraud would negatively affect our profitability, and could hurt our reputation and our brand. This could lead advertisers to become dissatisfied with our advertising programs, which could lead to loss of advertisers and revenue.
 
 We face government regulation and legal uncertainties, which could increase our costs or limit our business opportunities.
 
The growth and development of the market for internet commerce and communications has prompted both federal and state laws and regulations concerning the collection and use of personally identifiable information (including consumer credit and financial information under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act), consumer protection, the content of online publications, the taxation of online transactions and the transmission of unsolicited commercial email, popularly known as “spam.” More laws and regulations are under consideration by various governments, agencies and industry self-regulatory groups. Although our compliance with applicable federal and state laws, regulations and industry guidelines has not had a material adverse effect on us, new laws and regulations may be introduced and modifications to existing laws may be enacted that require us to make changes to our business practices. Although we believe that our practices are in compliance with applicable laws, regulations and policies, if we were required to defend our practices against investigations of state or federal agencies or if our practices were deemed to be a violation of applicable laws, regulations or policies, we could be penalized and our activities enjoined. Any of the foregoing could increase the cost of conducting online activities, decrease demand for our services, and lessen our ability to effectively market our services, or otherwise materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
Our activities may include, among other things, the offering of stand-alone services providing fund recommendations and analysis to subscribers, in contrast to providing such information as part of a larger online financial publication of more general and regular circulation. As a result, we may in the future be required to register with the Securities and Exchange Commission as an investment advisor under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940. The securities industry in the United States is subject to extensive regulation under both federal and state laws. A failure to comply with regulations applicable to securities industry participants could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. Investment advisors are subject to Securities and Exchange Commission regulations covering all aspects of the operation of their business, including, among others:
 
    ·   
advertising,
    ·     
record-keeping,
    ·     
conduct of directors, officers and employees, and
    ·     
supervision of advisory activities.
 
Violations of the regulations governing the actions of investment advisors may result in the imposition of censures or fines, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders, and the suspension or expulsion of us, our officers, or our employees from the securities business. Our ability to comply with all applicable securities laws and rules is largely dependent on our establishment and maintenance of appropriate compliance systems (including proper supervisory procedures and books and records requirements), as well as our ability to attract and retain qualified compliance personnel. Because we operate in an industry subject to extensive regulation, new regulation, changes in existing regulation, or changes in the interpretation or enforcement of existing laws and rules could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Our assets will include intellectual property (such as domain names).  Under accounting rules, we will be required to value these assets on an annual basis.  It is possible that the value of the assets may be impaired.
 
We may not be able to protect the web site address that is important to our business.
 
Our web site address, or domain names, is important to our business.  The regulation of domain names is subject to change. Some proposed changes include the creation of additional top-level domains in addition to the current top-level domains, such as “.com,” “.net” and “.org.”  It is also possible that the requirements for holding a domain name could change.  Therefore, we may not be able to obtain or maintain relevant domain names for all of the areas of our business.  It may also be difficult for us to prevent third parties from acquiring domain names that are similar to ours, that infringe our trademarks or that otherwise decrease the value of our intellectual property.
 
 
20

 
 
 Government regulations and legal uncertainties could affect the growth of the internet.
 
A number of legislative and regulatory proposals under consideration by federal, state, local and foreign governmental organizations may lead to laws or regulations concerning various aspects of the internet, including online content, user privacy, access charges, liability for third-party activities and jurisdiction. Additionally, it is uncertain as to how existing laws will be applied to the internet. The adoption of new laws or the application of existing laws may decrease the growth in the use of the internet, which could in turn decrease the usage and demand for our services or increase our cost of doing business.
 
Some local telephone carriers have asserted that the increasing popularity and use of the internet have burdened the existing telecommunications infrastructure, and that many areas with high internet use have begun to experience interruptions in telephone service. These carriers have petitioned the Federal Communications Commission to impose access fees on internet service providers and online service providers. If access fees are imposed, the costs of communicating on the internet could increase substantially, potentially slowing the increasing use of the internet. This could in turn decrease demand for our services or increase our cost of doing business.
 
Taxation of internet transactions could slow the use of the internet.
 
The tax treatment of the internet and electronic commerce is currently unsettled.  A number of proposals have been made at the federal, state and local level and by various foreign governments to impose taxes on the sale of goods and services and other internet activities.  The internet Tax Information Act places a three-year moratorium on new state and local taxes on internet commerce.  However, future laws may impose taxes or other regulations on internet commerce, which could substantially impair the growth of electronic commerce.
 
We depend on continued improvements to our computer network and the infrastructure of the internet.
 
Any failure of our computer systems that causes interruption or slower response time of our website or services could result in a smaller number of users of our website.  If sustained or repeated, these performance issues could reduce the attractiveness of our website to consumers and our products and services to investment professionals and internet advertisers.  Increases in the volume of our website traffic could also strain the capacity of our existing computer systems, which could lead to slower response times or system failures.  This would cause the number of search inquiries, other revenue producing offerings and our informational offerings to decline, any of which could hurt our revenue growth and our brand loyalty.  We may need to incur additional costs to upgrade our computer systems in order to accommodate increased demand if our systems cannot handle current or higher volumes of traffic.
 
The recent growth in internet traffic has caused frequent periods of decreased performance. Our ability to increase the speed with which we provide services to consumers and to increase the scope of these services is limited by and dependent upon the speed and reliability of the internet. Consequently, the emergence and growth of the market for our services is dependent on the performance of and future improvements to the internet.
 
Our internal network infrastructure could be disrupted.
 
Our operations will depend upon our ability to maintain and protect our computer systems.  Our systems, when they are operational will be vulnerable to damage from break-ins, unauthorized access, vandalism, fire, earthquakes, power loss, telecommunications failures and similar events.
 
Experienced computer programmers, or hackers, may attempt to penetrate our network security from time to time. A hacker who penetrates our network security could misappropriate proprietary information or cause interruptions in our services.  We might be required to expend significant capital and resources to protect against, or to alleviate, problems caused by hackers.  We also may not have a timely remedy against a hacker who is able to penetrate our network security.  In addition to purposeful security breaches, the inadvertent transmission of computer viruses could expose us to litigation or to a material risk of loss.
 
 
21

 
 
We could face liability for information on our website and for products and services sold over the internet.
 
We will provide third-party content on our website.  We could be exposed to liability with respect to this third-party information.  Persons might assert, among other things, that, by directly or indirectly providing links to websites operated by third parties, we should be liable for copyright or trademark infringement or other wrongful actions by the third parties operating those websites.  They could also assert that our third party information contains errors or omissions, and consumers could seek damages for losses incurred if they rely upon incorrect information.
 
We may enter into agreements with other companies under which we share with these other companies’ revenues resulting from the purchase of services through direct links to or from our web site.  These arrangements may expose us to additional legal risks and uncertainties, including local, state, federal and foreign government regulation and potential liabilities to consumers of these services, even if we do not provide the services ourselves.  We cannot assure you that any indemnification provided to us in our agreements with these parties, if available, will be adequate.  Even if these claims do not result in liability to us, we could incur significant costs in investigating and defending against these claims.  Our general liability insurance may not cover all potential claims to which we are exposed and may not be adequate to indemnify us for all liability that may be imposed.
 
Acquisitions that we may undertake will involve a number of inherent risks, any of which could cause us not to realize the benefits anticipated to result.
 
Our strategy includes expanding our assets and operations through combinations or acquisitions.  Integrating newly-acquired businesses is expensive and time consuming.  Combinations and acquisitions involve inherent risks, such as:
 
    ·   
uncertainties in assessing the value, strengths and potential profitability of, and identifying the extent of all weaknesses, risks, contingent and other liabilities of, acquisition or other transaction candidates;
    ·   
the potential of key management and employees of an acquired business;
    ·
the ability to achieve identified operating and financial synergies anticipated to result from a combination or acquisition;
    ·
problems that could arise from the integration of the acquired business or assets; and
    ·
unanticipated changes in business, industry or general economic conditions that affect the assumptions underlying the combination or acquisition.
 
Any one or more of these factors could cause us not to realize the benefits anticipated to result from any combination or acquisition or could result in unexpected liabilities.
 
Risks Related to Exchange Traded Funds

General Risks
 
Exchange traded funds are subject to a number of risks that may affect the value of its shares. The value of an investment in the ETF is based on the performance of the Underlying ETFs in which it invests and the allocation of its assets among those Underlying ETFs.  The key risks of an investment in an ETF include the key risks of investing in the Underlying ETFs.  The EFTs share price will fluctuate.  An investor could lose money on his or its investment and the particular ETF invested in Fund could also return less than other investments:

·  
If the securities market as a whole goes down;
·  
 If any of the Underlying ETFs in the portfolio do not increase in value as expected;
·  
If interest rates go up, causing the value of debt securities held by an Underlying ETF to decline;
·  
If the issuer of a debt security is unable to make timely payments of principal or interest when due;
·  
If returns from the types of securities in which an Underlying ETF invests underperform returns from the various general securities markets or different asset classes;
·  
Because investments in foreign securities may have more frequent and larger price changes than U.S. securities and may lose value due to changes in currency exchange rates and other factors;
·  
Because an Underlying ETF may, at various times, concentrate in the securities of a particular industry, group of industries, or sector, and when a fund is overweighted in an industry, group of industries, or sector, it may be more sensitive to any single economic, business, political, or regulatory occurrence than a fund that is not overweighted in an industry, group of industries, or sector;
·  
Because the market value of exchange-traded fund shares may differ from their net asset value as a result of market supply and demand, the shares may trade at a premium or discount;
·  
If the sub-advisor’s asset allocation decisions do not anticipate market trends successfully; and
·  
As with any fund, there is no guaranty that an ETF will achieve its goals.
 
 
22

 
 
Additional Risks of ETFs
 
Liquidity Risk – Trading in shares may be halted because of market conditions or for reasons that, in the view of the Exchange, make trading in shares inadvisable. In addition, trading in shares is subject to trading halts caused by extraordinary market volatility pursuant to “circuit breaker” rules. There can be no assurance that the requirements necessary to maintain the listing of the shares of the Funds will continue to be met or will remain unchanged.
 
Trading Risk  Shares may trade below their NAV. The NAV of shares will fluctuate with changes in the market value of the Fund’s holdings. The trading prices of shares will fluctuate in accordance with changes in NAV as well as market supply and demand. However, given that shares can be created and redeemed only in Creation Units at NAV (unlike shares of many closed-end mutual funds, which frequently trade at appreciable discounts from, and sometimes premiums to, their NAVs), the Advisor does not believe that large discounts or premiums to NAV will exist for extended periods of time.
 
Early Closing Risk – The normal close of trading of securities listed on Nasdaq and the NYSE is 4:00 p.m., Eastern Time. Unanticipated early closings of securities exchanges and other financial markets may result in the Fund’s or an Underlying ETF’s inability to buy or sell securities or other financial instruments on that day.  If an exchange or market closes early on a day when the Fund or an Underlying ETF needs to execute a high volume of trades late in a trading day, the Fund or an Underlying ETF might incur substantial trading losses.
 
            Equity Risk – The equity markets are volatile, and the value of the ETFs’ equity securities, may fluctuate significantly from day to day.  This volatility may cause the value of your investment in the Fund to decrease.
 
Fixed Income Risk – An ETF’s investment in fixed income securities will change in value in response to interest rate changes and other factors, such as the perception of the issuer’s creditworthiness.  For example, the value of fixed income securities will generally decrease when interest rates rise, which may cause the value of an ETF to decrease. In addition, an EFTs’ investment in fixed income securities with longer maturities will fluctuate more in response to interest rate changes.
 
Foreign Currency Risk  An ETF may hold securities denominated in foreign currency.  The value of securities denominated in foreign currencies can change when foreign currencies strengthen or weaken relative to the U.S. Dollar. These currency movements may negatively impact the value of an ETF security even when there is no change in the value of the security in the issuer’s home country.
 
Foreign Securities Risk – An EFTs’ investments in securities of foreign companies can be more volatile than investments in U.S. companies. Diplomatic, political, or economic developments could adversely affect investment in foreign countries. Foreign companies generally are not subject to accounting, auditing, and financial reporting standards comparable to those applicable to U.S. companies.
 
The SEC has and continues to review the underlying trading instruments and their respective suitability with an ETF structure.  This may result in a delay in originating new ETFs into the market and create a negative impact on future revenue.

Risks Related to Our Investment Management Business

The investment management business, especially in the fund-of-funds and manager seeding arena, is intensely competitive.
 
The investment management business is intensely competitive, with competition based on a variety of factors, including investment performance, the quality of service provided to clients, investor liquidity and willingness to invest, fund terms (including fees), brand recognition and business reputation.  Our investment management business competes with a number of fund-of-fund managers and other private investment fund managers and financial institutions.  A number of factors serve to increase our competitive risks:
 
 
23

 
 
·  
a number of our competitors in some of our businesses have greater financial, technical, marketing and other resources and more personnel than we do;
·  
a significant number of investors have materially decreased or temporarily stopped making new private investment fund investments recently because of the global economic downturn and generally poor returns in their overall alternative asset investment portfolios in 2008 and 2009;
·  
some of our private investment funds may not perform as well as competitors’ funds or other available investment products;
·  
some of these competitors may also have a lower cost of capital and access to funding sources that are not available to us, which may create competitive disadvantages for us with respect to investment opportunities;
·  
some of our competitors may have more flexibility than us in raising certain types of private investment funds under the investment management contracts they have negotiated with their investors;
·  
some of our competitors may have higher risk tolerances, different risk assessments or lower return thresholds, which could allow them to consider a wider variety of investments in underlying hedge funds, private equity funds and other private investment funds in which we invest and to bid more aggressively than us for investments that we want to make;
·  
some of our competitors may have better expertise or be regarded by investors as having better expertise than we do in selecting underlying funds in which to invest in a specific asset class or geographic region; and
·  
other industry participants will from time to time seek to recruit our investment professionals and other employees away from us.
 
We may lose investment opportunities in the future if we do not match investment prices, structures and terms offered by competitors.  Alternatively, we may experience decreased rates of return and increased risks of loss if we match investment prices, structures and terms offered by competitors. Moreover, if we are forced to compete with other alternative investment managers on the basis of price, we may not be able to maintain our current fee structures and carried interest terms. We have historically competed primarily on the performance of our funds, and not on the level of our fees or carried interest relative to those of our competitors. However, there is a risk that fees and carried interest in the overall alternative investment management industry will decline, without regard to the historical performance of a manager. Fee or carried interest income reductions on existing or future funds, without corresponding decreases in our cost structure, would adversely affect our revenues and profitability.
 
In addition, the attractiveness of our funds relative to investments in other investment products could decrease depending on economic conditions. This competitive pressure could adversely affect our ability to make successful investments and limit our ability to raise future funds, either of which would adversely impact our business, revenue, results of operations and cash flow.

Poor performance of our funds could cause a decline in our revenue, income, and cash flow, and could adversely affect our ability to raise capital for future funds.
 
In the event that any of our funds were to perform poorly, our revenue, income and cash flow would decline because the value of our assets under management would decrease, which would result in a reduction in management fees, and our investment returns would decrease, resulting in a reduction in the carried interest and incentive fees we earn.
 
Poor performance of our funds could make it more difficult for us to raise new capital. Investors in our funds might decline to invest in future funds we raise and investors might withdraw their investments as a result of poor performance of the funds in which they are invested. Investors and potential investors in our funds continually assess our funds’ performance, and our ability to raise capital for existing and future funds and avoid excessive redemption levels will depend on our funds’ continued satisfactory performance. Accordingly, poor fund performance may deter future investment in our funds and thereby decrease the capital invested in our funds and ultimately, our management fee income. Alternatively, in the face of poor performance, investors could demand lower fees or fee concessions which would likewise decrease our revenue.

 
Our investment management business depends in large part on our ability to raise capital from third party investors. If we are unable to raise capital from third party investors, we would be unable to collect management fees or deploy their capital into investments in underlying funds and potentially collect carried interest, which would materially reduce our revenue and cash flow and adversely affect our financial condition.
 
Our ability to raise capital from third party investors depends on a number of factors, including certain factors that are outside our control. Certain factors, such as the performance of the stock market or the asset allocation rules or regulations to which such third party investors are subject, could inhibit or restrict the ability of third party investors to make investments in our funds or the underlying funds or asset classes of the underlying funds in which our funds invest.
 
 
24

 
 
In addition, in connection with raising new funds or making further investments in existing funds, we negotiate terms for such funds and investments with existing and potential investors. The outcome of such negotiations could result in our agreement to terms that are materially less favorable to us than for prior funds we have managed or funds managed by our competitors. Such terms could restrict our ability to raise funds with investment objectives or strategies that compete with existing funds, add additional expenses and obligations for us in managing our funds or increase our potential liabilities, all of which could ultimately reduce our revenues.

Third party investors in our funds with commitment-based structures may not satisfy their contractual obligation to fund capital calls when requested by us, which could adversely affect a fund’s operations and performance.
 
Investors in some of our funds make capital commitments to those funds that we are entitled to call from those investors at any time during prescribed periods. We depend on investors fulfilling their commitments when we call capital from them in order for those funds to consummate investments in and satisfy capital calls by underlying funds and otherwise satisfy obligations (for example, management fees) when due.  Any investor that did not fund a capital call would generally be subject to several possible penalties, including having a significant amount of its existing investment forfeited in that fund. However, the impact of the penalty is correlated to the amount of capital previously invested by the investor in the fund and if an investor has invested little or no capital, for instance early in the life of the fund, then the forfeiture penalty may not be as meaningful. Investors may also negotiate for lesser or reduced penalties at the outset of the fund, thereby inhibiting our ability to enforce the funding of a capital call. If investors were to fail to satisfy a significant amount of capital calls for any particular fund, the operation and performance of such fund could be materially and adversely affected.

The due diligence process that we undertake in connection with investments by our funds may not reveal all facts that may be relevant in connection with an investment in an underlying fund.
 
Before making investments in underlying funds on behalf of the funds-of-funds we manage, we conduct due diligence that we deem reasonable and appropriate based on the facts and circumstances applicable to each investment. When conducting due diligence, we may be required to evaluate important and complex business, financial, tax, accounting, and legal issues. Outside consultants, legal advisors, and accountants may be involved in the due diligence process in varying degrees depending on the type of investment. Nevertheless, when conducting due diligence and making an assessment regarding an investment, we rely on the resources available to us, including information provided by underlying funds. The due diligence investigation that we will carry out with respect to any investment opportunity may not reveal or highlight all relevant facts (including fraud) that may be necessary or helpful in evaluating such investment opportunity. Moreover, such an investigation will not necessarily result in the investment being successful.
 
In connection with the due diligence we conduct in making and monitoring investments in third-party funds, we rely on information supplied by such third-party funds or by service providers to such third-party funds. The information we receive from them may not be accurate or complete and therefore we may not have all the relevant facts necessary to properly assess and monitor our funds’ investment in a particular fund.

Our investment management activities involve investments in relatively high-risk, illiquid securities of underlying private investment funds and private investment fund managers, and we may fail to realize any profits from these activities for a considerable period of time or lose some or all of our principal investments.

Many of our funds invest in securities of underlying funds and underlying fund managers that are not publicly traded. In many cases, our funds may be prohibited by contract or by applicable securities laws from selling such securities for a period of time. Our funds will generally not be able to sell these securities publicly unless their sale is registered under applicable securities laws, or unless an exemption from such registration is available.  Under certain conditions, our funds may be forced to either sell securities at lower prices than they had expected to realize or defer—potentially for a considerable period of time—sales that they had planned to make.
 
 
25

 
 
Valuation methodologies for certain assets in the underlying funds in which our funds invest can be subject to significant subjectivity and the values of such assets established pursuant to such methodologies may never be realized, which could result in significant losses for our funds.
 
There are no readily ascertainable market prices for a large number of the illiquid investments held by underlying funds in which our funds-of-funds invest.  The fair value of the investments of such underlying funds is determined periodically by the managers of such underlying funds using a number of methodologies. These methodologies may be based on a number of factors, including the nature of the investment, the expected cash flows from the investment, bid or ask prices provided by third parties for the investment, the length of time the investment has been held, the trading price of securities (in the case of publicly-traded securities), restrictions on transfer and other recognized valuation methodologies. The methodologies used in valuing individual investments are based on a variety of estimates and assumptions specific to the particular investments, and actual results related to the investment may vary materially as a result of the inaccuracy of such assumptions or estimates. These valuation methodologies can involve a significant degree of management judgment.  In addition, because the illiquid investments held by underlying funds in which we invest may be in industries or sectors which are unstable, in distress, or undergoing some uncertainty, such investments are subject to rapid changes in value caused by sudden company-specific or industry-specific developments.
 
Because valuations, and in particular valuations of investments for which market quotations are not readily available, are inherently uncertain, may fluctuate over short periods of time and may be based on estimates, determinations of fair value may differ materially from the values that would have resulted if a ready market had existed. Even if market quotations were available for such investments, such quotations may not reflect the value that could actually be realized because of various factors, including the possible illiquidity associated with a large ownership position, subsequent illiquidity in the market for a company’s securities, future market price volatility or the potential for a future loss in market value based on poor industry conditions on the market’s view of overall company and management performance.
 
Because there is significant uncertainty in the valuation of or in the stability of the value of illiquid investments, the fair values of such investments as reflected in one of our funds or an underlying fund’s net asset value do not necessarily reflect the prices that could actually be obtained when such investments are sold. Realizations at values significantly lower than the values at which investments have been reflected in net asset values would result in losses for the applicable fund, a decline in management fees and the loss of potential incentive income. Also, a situation where asset values turn out to be materially different from values reflected in net asset values may cause investors to lose confidence in us which could, in turn, result in redemptions or difficulties in our ability to raise additional capital.

Our failure to deal appropriately with conflicts of interest in our investment business could damage our reputation and adversely affect our businesses.
 
Certain of our funds may have overlapping investment objectives, including funds that have different fee structures, and potential conflicts may arise with respect to our decisions regarding how to allocate investment opportunities among those funds.  In addition, conflicts of interest may exist in the valuation of our investments and regarding decisions about the allocation of specific investment opportunities among us and our funds and the allocation of fees and costs among us, our funds and their underlying funds. To the extent we failed to appropriately deal with any such conflicts, it could negatively impact our reputation and ability to raise additional funds or result in potential litigation against us.

We are subject to third-party litigation risk which could result in significant liabilities and reputational harm which could materially adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, and liquidity.
 
We may be subject to litigation arising from investor dissatisfaction with the performance of our funds. In addition, we are exposed to risks of litigation or investigation relating to transactions which presented conflicts of interest that were not properly addressed. In such actions we would be obligated to bear legal, settlement and other costs, which may be in excess of any available insurance coverage. In addition, although we are indemnified by our funds, our rights to indemnification may be challenged. If we are required to incur all or a portion of the costs arising out of litigation or investigations as a result of inadequate insurance proceeds, if any, or fail to obtain indemnification from our funds, our results of operations, financial condition and liquidity would be materially adversely affected.
 
In our funds, we are exposed to the risk of litigation if the funds suffer catastrophic losses due to the failure of our investment strategy. Any litigation arising in such circumstances is likely to be protracted, expensive, and surrounded by circumstances which are materially damaging to our reputation and our business.  In addition, we face the risk of litigation from investors in our funds if we violate restrictions in such funds’ organizational documents (for example, by failing to adhere to the limits we have to set on maximum exposure by a fund to a single investment).
 
Certain of our funds are incorporated or formed under the laws of foreign countries, such as the Cayman Islands. Such laws, particularly with respect to shareholders rights, partner rights and bankruptcy, differ from the laws of the United States and could change, possibly to the detriment of our funds and investment management subsidiaries.
 
 
26

 
 
We often pursue investment opportunities that involve business, regulatory, legal or other complexities.
 
We pursue unusually complex investment opportunities, such as manager seeding. This can entail substantial business, regulatory or legal complexity that would deter other investment managers. Our tolerance for complexity presents risks, as such transactions can be more difficult, expensive, and time-consuming to finance and execute; it can be more difficult to manage or realize value from such transactions; and such transactions sometimes entail a higher level of regulatory risk or a greater risk of contingent liabilities. Any of these risks could harm the performance of our funds.

Investors in our funds may redeem their investments, which could lead to a substantial decrease in our revenues.
 
Investors in our funds may generally redeem their investments on an annual, semi-annual, or quarterly basis following the expiration of a specified period of time when capital may not be withdrawn (typically between one and three years), subject to the applicable fund’s specific redemption provisions. In a declining market, the pace of redemptions and consequent reduction in our assets under management could accelerate. The decrease in revenues that would result from significant redemptions in our funds could have a material adverse effect on our business, revenues, net income, and cash flows.

Our funds may concentrate their investments in a small number of underlying funds and certain of these underlying funds may concentrate their investments in certain asset types or in a geographic region, which could exacerbate any negative performance of those underlying funds, and consequently, our funds, to the extent those concentrated investments perform poorly.
 
The governing agreements of our funds and the underlying funds in which they invest may contain only limited investment restrictions and only limited requirements as to diversification of investments, either by geographic region or asset type.  During periods of difficult market conditions or slowdowns in these sectors, the decreased revenues, difficulty in obtaining access to financing and increased funding costs experienced by our funds may be exacerbated by this concentration of investments, which would result in lower investment returns for our funds.

Private fund investments are subject to numerous additional risks.

Investments by our funds in underlying private investment funds, such as hedge funds and private equity funds, are subject to numerous additional risks, including the following:

·  
Certain of these underlying funds are newly established without any operating history or are managed by management companies or general partners who may not have as significant track records as an independent manager.
·  
Generally, there are few limitations on the execution of the underlying funds’ investment strategies, which are subject to the sole discretion of the management company or the general partner of such underlying funds.
·  
The underlying funds may engage in short selling, which is subject to the theoretically unlimited risk of loss because there is no limit on how much the price of a security may appreciate before the short position is closed out. An underlying fund may be subject to losses if a security lender demands return of the lent securities and an alternative lending source cannot be found or if the underlying fund is otherwise unable to borrow securities that are necessary to hedge its positions.
·  
The underlying funds may be exposed to the risk that a counterparty will not settle a transaction in accordance with its terms and conditions because of a dispute over the terms of the contract (whether or not bona fide) or because of a credit or liquidity problem, thus causing the underlying fund to suffer a loss. Counterparty risk is accentuated for contracts with longer maturities where events may intervene to prevent settlement, or where the underlying fund has concentrated its transactions with a single or small group of counterparties. Generally, underlying funds are not restricted from dealing with any particular counterparty or from concentrating any or all of their transactions with one counterparty. Moreover, the underlying funds’ internal consideration of the creditworthiness of their counterparties may prove insufficient. The absence of a regulated market to facilitate settlement may increase the potential for losses.
·  
Credit risk may arise through a default by one of several large institutions that are dependent on one another to meet their liquidity or operational needs, so that a default by one institution causes a series of defaults by the other institutions. This “systemic risk” may adversely affect the financial intermediaries (such as clearing agencies, clearing houses, banks, securities firms and exchanges) with which the underlying funds interact on a daily basis.
 
 
27

 
 
·  
The efficacy of investment and trading strategies depend largely on the ability to establish and maintain an overall market position in a combination of financial instruments. An underlying fund’s trading orders may not be executed in a timely and efficient manner due to various circumstances, including systems failures or human error. In such event, the underlying funds might only be able to acquire some but not all of the components of the position, or if the overall position were to need adjustment, the funds might not be able to make such adjustment. As a result, the underlying funds would not be able to achieve the market position selected by the management company or general partner of such underlying funds, and might incur a loss in liquidating their position.
·  
Underlying funds are subject to risks due to potential illiquidity of assets.Underlying funds may make investments or hold trading positions in markets that are volatile and which may become illiquid. Timely divestiture or sale of trading positions can be impaired by decreased trading volume, increased price volatility, concentrated trading positions, limitations on the ability to transfer positions in highly specialized or structured transactions to which they may be a party, and changes in industry and government regulations. It may be impossible or costly for underlying funds to liquidate positions rapidly in order to meet margin calls, withdrawal requests or otherwise, particularly if there are other market participants seeking to dispose of similar assets at the same time or the relevant market is otherwise moving against a position or in the event of trading halts or daily price movement limits on the market or otherwise. Moreover, these risks may be exacerbated for our funds of hedge funds. For example, if one of our funds were to invest a significant portion of its assets in two or more underlying funds that each had illiquid positions in the same issuer, the illiquidity risk for our funds would be compounded.  Moreover, certain of our funds are invested in underlying funds that may halt redemptions.
·  
Underlying fund investments are subject to risks relating to investments in commodities, futures, options and other derivatives, the prices of which are highly volatile and may be subject to the theoretically unlimited risk of loss in certain circumstances, including if the underlying fund writes a call option. Price movements of commodities, futures and options contracts and payments pursuant to swap agreements are influenced by, among other things, interest rates, changing supply and demand relationships, trade, fiscal, monetary and exchange control programs and policies of governments and national and international political and economic events and policies. The value of futures, options and swap agreements also depends upon the price of the commodities underlying them. In addition, underlying funds’ assets are subject to the risk of the failure of any of the exchanges on which their positions trade or of their clearinghouses or counterparties. Most U.S. commodities exchanges limit fluctuations in certain commodity interest prices during a single day by imposing “daily price fluctuation limits” or “daily limits,” the existence of which may reduce liquidity or effectively curtail trading in particular markets.

Increased regulatory focus could result in additional burdens on our business.
 
As a result of highly-publicized financial scandals in recent years, investors, regulators and the general public exhibited concerns over the integrity of both the U.S. financial markets and the regulatory oversight of these markets. As a result, the business environment in which we operate is subject to heightened regulation. With respect to alternative investment management funds, in recent years, there has been debate in both U.S. and foreign governments about new rules or regulations, including increased oversight or taxation. As calls for additional regulation have increased, there may be a related increase in regulatory investigations of the trading and other investment activities of alternative investment funds, including our private investment funds. Such investigations may impose additional expenses on us, may require the attention of senior management and may result in fines if any of our private investment funds are deemed to have violated any regulations.

Risks Related to the Professional Employer Organization Business

The workers’ compensation loss reserves may be inadequate to cover the ultimate liability for workers’ compensation costs.

Vensure maintains reserves (recorded as accrued liabilities on our balance sheet) to cover estimated liabilities for large deductible workers’ compensation claims. The determination of these reserves is based upon a number of factors, including current and historical claims activity, claims payment patterns and medical cost trends and developments in existing claims. Accordingly, reserves do not represent an exact calculation of liability. Reserves can be affected by both internal and external events, such as adverse developments on existing claims or changes in medical costs, medical condition of the claimant, claims handling procedures, administrative costs, inflation, and legal trends and legislative changes. Reserves are adjusted from time to time to reflect new claims, claim developments, or systemic changes, and such adjustments are reflected in the results of the periods in which the reserves are changed. The estimated accrual for workers’ compensation claims liabilities is based upon an actuarial estimate provided by an independent actuary. The estimated accrual does not include an estimated provision for the incidence of unknown catastrophic claims. Moreover, because of the uncertainties that surround estimating workers’ compensation loss reserves, it cannot be certain that the reserves are adequate. If reserves are insufficient to cover actual losses, Vensure would have to increase the reserves and incur charges to earnings that could be material to the results of operations and financial condition.
 
 
28

 
 
The self-insured retention for workers’ compensation claims is between $250,000 and $500,000 per occurrence in the majority of large deductible states but will be increasing to $1.0 million in the near future.

In view of Vensure’s favorable historical experience with large catastrophic claims and an opportunity to realize savings from lower excess workers’ compensation insurance premiums, they will be increasing the self-insured retention to $1.0 million per occurrence. Thus, Vensure will have financial risk for most workers’ compensation claims under $1.0 million, on a per occurrence basis. This level of per occurrence retention may result in higher workers’ compensation costs with a corresponding negative effect on operating results and financial condition.

Adverse developments in the market for excess workers’ compensation insurance could lead to increases in costs.

To manage the financial exposure in the event of catastrophic injuries or fatalities, Vensure currently maintains excess workers’ compensation insurance with a per occurrence retention of up to $500,000 effective July 1, 2009. Prior thereto, the maximum per occurrence retention was $250,000. Access to affordable insurance may lead to limited availability of such coverage, additional increases in our insurance costs or further increases in the self-insured retention, any of which may have a material adverse effect on Vensure’s financial condition.

Current economic conditions may impact our ability to attract new PEO clients and cause Vensure’s existing PEO clients to reduce staffing levels or cease operations.

The current economic downturn is having a negative impact on small and medium size businesses, which make up the majority of Vensure’s PEO clients. In turn, these businesses are cutting costs, including trimming employees from their payrolls, or ceasing operations altogether. In addition, businesses may be reluctant to enter into new PEO arrangements because of the uncertainty regarding the timing of any economic recovery. These forces may result in decreased PEO revenues due both to the downsizing of current clients and difficulties in attracting new clients, and may also result in additional bad debt expense to the extent that existing clients cease operations.
 
Because Vensure assumse the obligation to make wage, tax and regulatory payments in respect of some employees, they are exposed to client credit risks.

Vensure generally assume responsibility for and manage the risks associated with our clients’ employee payroll obligations, including liability for payment of salaries and wages (including payroll taxes), as well as group health and retirement benefits. These obligations are fixed by statute in certain states where business is conducted, whether or not the client makes payments as required by services agreements, which exposes Vensure to credit risks. Vensure attempts to mitigate this risk by invoicing clients at the end of their specific payroll processing cycle. Vensure also carefully monitors the timeliness of clients’ payments and imposes strict credit standards on customers. If Vensure fails to successfully manage credit risk, Vensure’s results of operations and financial condition could be materially and adversely affected.

Increases in unemployment claims could raise Vensure’s state unemployment tax rates which we may not be able to be passed on to the customers.

During weak economic conditions in the markets currently experiencing, the level of unemployment claims tend to raise as a result of employee layoffs at PEO clients. The rise in unemployment claims often results in higher state unemployment tax rates which in some instances cannot be concurrently passed on to the customers either due to competitive pricing pressures. Increases in state unemployment tax rates could have a material adverse effect on Vensure’s results of operations, particularly in the early part of the calendar year when effective payroll tax rates are at or near their maximum.

If Vensure is determined not to be an “employer” under certain laws and regulations, their clients may stop using the services, and Vensure may be subject to additional liabilities.

Vensure believes that it is an employer of employees provided to the PEO clients on a co-employment basis under the various laws and regulations of the Internal Revenue Service and the U.S. Department of Labor. If Vensure is determined not to be an employer under such laws and regulations and are therefore unable to assume obligations of the clients, they may view such potential liability as an unacceptable risk, discouraging current clients from continuing a relationship with Vensure or prospective clients from entering into a new relationship with Vensure.
 
 
29

 
 
Any determination that Vensure is not an employer for purposes of ERISA could adversely affect the cafeteria benefits plan operated under Section 125 of the Internal Revenue Code and result in liabilities under the plan.

Vensure may be exposed to employment-related claims and costs and periodic litigation that could adversely affect the business and results of operations.

Vensure co-employs employees in connection with the PEO. As such, Vensure may be subject to a number of risks inherent to the status as an employer, including without limitation:
 
 
 
claims of misconduct or negligence on the part of the employees, discrimination or harassment claims against the employees, or claims by the employees of discrimination or harassment by the clients;
 
 
 
immigration-related claims;
 
 
 
claims relating to violations of wage, hour and other workplace regulations;
 
 
 
claims relating to employee benefits, entitlements to employee benefits, or errors in the calculation or administration of such benefits; and
 
 
 
possible claims relating to misuse of customer confidential information, misappropriation of assets or other similar claims.

If Vensure experiences significant incidents involving any of the above-described risk areas, it could face substantial out-of-pocket losses, fines or negative publicity. In addition, such claims may give rise to litigation, which may be time consuming, distracting and costly, and could have a material adverse effect on the business. With respect to claims involving the co-employer relationship with PEO clients, although the PEO services agreement provides that the client will indemnify Vensure for any liability attributable to the conduct of the client or its employees, Vensure may not be able to enforce such contractual indemnification, or the client may not have sufficient assets to satisfy its obligations to Vensure.
 
Vensure operates in a complex regulatory environment, and failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations could adversely affect their business.

Corporate human resource operations are subject to a broad range of complex and evolving laws and regulations, including those applicable to payroll practices, benefits administration, employment practices and privacy. Because the clients have employees in many states throughout the United States, Vensure must perform services in compliance with the legal and regulatory requirements of multiple jurisdictions. Some of these laws and regulations may be difficult to ascertain or interpret and may change from time to time. Violation of such laws and regulations could subject Vensure to fines and penalties, damage our reputation, constitute a breach of client agreements, impair the ability to obtain and renew required licenses, and decrease profitability or competitiveness. If any of these effects were to occur, operating results and financial condition could be adversely affected.

Changes in government regulations may result in restrictions or prohibitions applicable to the provision of employment services or the imposition of additional licensing, regulatory or tax requirements.

Vensure’s PEO and staffing businesses are heavily regulated in most jurisdictions in which they operate. In most states, the industry is regulated by the state department of insurance. Other states regulate the industry through the equivalent of the Corporation Commission. Vensure cannot assure that the states in which they conduct or seek to conduct business will not:
 
 
 
impose additional regulations that prohibit or restrict employment-related businesses like Vensure’s;
 
 
 
require additional licensing or add restrictions on existing licenses to provide employment-related services; or
 
 
 
increase taxes or make changes in the way in which taxes are calculated for providers of employment-related services.
 
 
30

 
 
Any changes in applicable laws and regulations may make it more difficult or expensive to do business, inhibit expansion of the business, or result in additional expenses that limit profitability or decrease ability to attract and retain clients. Due to Vensure’s dramatic growth over the past eight months, Vensure is currently working to ensure that they are properly licensed in each state in which they conduct business.

Vensure may find it difficult to expand the business into additional states due to varying state regulatory requirements.

Future growth in Vensure’s operations depends, in part, on the ability to offer services to prospective clients in new states, which may subject Vensure to different regulatory requirements and standards. In order to operate effectively in a new state, Vensure must obtain all necessary regulatory approvals, adapt procedures to that state’s regulatory requirements and modify service offerings to adapt to local market conditions. In the event that Vensure expands into additional states, it may not be able to duplicate in other markets the financial performance experienced in the current markets.
 
Acquisitions subject Vensure to various risks, including risks relating to selection and pricing of acquisition targets, integration of acquired companies into their business and assumption of unanticipated liabilities.

Vensure has completed three acquisitions since 2007 and may pursue additional acquisitions and investment opportunities. Vensure cannot assure, however, that it will be able to identify or consummate any additional acquisitions. If it does pursue acquisitions, it may not realize the anticipated benefits of such acquisitions. Acquisitions involve many risks, including risks relating to the assumption of unforeseen liabilities of an acquired business, adverse accounting charges resulting from the acquisition, and difficulties in integrating acquired companies into the business, both from a cultural perspective, as well as with respect to personnel and client retention and technological integration. Acquired liabilities may be significant and may adversely affect the financial condition and results of operations. Vensure’s inability to successfully integrate acquired businesses may lead to increased costs, failure to generate expected returns, accounting charges, or even a total loss of amounts invested, any of which could have a material adverse effect on the financial condition and results of operations.

Vensure faces competition from a number of other companies.
 
Vensure faces competition from various companies that may provide all or some of the services offered. Vensure competitors include companies that are focused on co-employment or PEO services, such as Administaff, Inc. and companies that primarily provide payroll processing services or ASO services, such as Automatic Data Processing, Inc. and Paychex, Inc. Vensure also face competition from information technology outsourcing firms and broad-based outsourcing and consulting firms that perform individual projects.
 
Several of the existing or potential competitors have substantially greater financial, technical and marketing resources than Vensure does, which may enable them to develop and expand their infrastructure and service offerings more quickly and achieve greater cost efficiencies; invest in new technologies; expand operations into new markets more rapidly; devote greater resources to marketing; compete for acquisitions more effectively and complete acquisitions more easily; and aggressively price products and services and increase benefits in ways that Vensure may not be able to match economically.

In order to compete effectively in Vensure’s markets, they must target the potential clients carefully, continue to improve efficiencies and the scope and quality of services, and rely on service quality, innovation, education and program clarity. If the competitive advantages are not compelling or sustainable, then Vensure is unlikely to achieve profitability and sustain it’s growth goals.

Vensure does not have an expansive in-house sales staff and therefore rely extensively on brokers to make referrals.

Vensure maintains only a minimal internal professional sales force. Instead, they rely heavily on insurance brokers to provide referrals to new business. In connection with these arrangements, Vensure pays a commission to brokers for new clients. As a result of the reliance on brokers, Vensure is dependent on firms and individuals that do not have an exclusive relationship with them. If Vensure is unable to maintain relationships with brokers, if brokers increase their fees or if brokers lose confidence in the services, Vensure could face declines in business and additional costs and uncertainties as they attempt to hire and train an internal sales force.
 
 
31

 
 
Vensure’s service agreements may be terminated on short notice, leaving them vulnerable to loss of a significant amount of customers in a short period of time, if business or regulatory conditions change or events occur that negatively affect their reputation.

Vensure’s PEO services agreements are generally terminable on 30 days’ notice by either Vensure or the client. As a result, the clients may terminate their agreement with Vensure at any time, making them particularly vulnerable to changing business or regulatory conditions or changes affecting their reputation or the reputation of the industry.

Vensure’s industry has at times received negative publicity and had some stigma associated with it that, if it were to predominate, could cause the business to decline.

PEOs periodically have been tarnished by negative publicity or scandals from poor business judgment or even outright fraud. If Vensure or the PEO industry faces negative publicity, customers’ confidence in the use of co-employed workers may deteriorate, and they may be unwilling to enter into or continue the co-employment relationships. If a negative perception were to prevail, it would be more difficult for Vensure to attract and retain customers.

Changes in state unemployment tax laws and regulations could adversely affect the business.

In recent years, there has been significant negative publicity relating to the use of PEO companies to shield employers from poor unemployment history and high unemployment taxes. New legislation enacted at the state or federal level to try to counter this perceived problem could have a material adverse effect on our business by limiting the ability to market services or making services less attractive to customers and potential customers.

Vensure is dependent upon technology services and if they experience damage, service interruptions or failures in the computer and telecommunications systems, or if the security measures are breached, the client relationships and the ability to attract new clients may be adversely affected.

Vensure’s business could be interrupted by damage to or disruption of the computer and telecommunications equipment and software systems, and they may lose data. Vensure’s clients’ businesses may be adversely affected by any system or equipment failure experienced. As a result of any of the foregoing, the relationships with clients may be impaired, Vensure may lose clients, the ability to attract new clients may be adversely affected and they could be exposed to contractual liability. Precautions in place to protect Vensure from, or minimize the effect of, such events, may not be adequate.

In addition, Vensure’s business involves the storage and transmission of clients’ proprietary information and confidential personal data of employees and security breaches could expose us to a risk of loss of this information, litigation and possible liability. If the security measures are breached as a result of third-party action, employee error, malfeasance or otherwise, and, as a result, someone obtains unauthorized access to client or employee data, Vensure’s reputation will be damaged, the business may suffer and Vensure could incur significant liability. Techniques used to obtain unauthorized access or to sabotage systems change frequently and are growing increasingly sophisticated. As a result, Vensure may be unable to anticipate these techniques or to implement adequate preventative measures. If an actual or perceived breach of the security occurs, Vensure could be liable and the market perception of the services could be harmed.

Risks Related to Our Educational Content Business

We are a relatively new company with limited revenues and there can be no assurance that our business model will succeed.

As Whyte Lyon’s operating history is limited, the revenue and income potential of our business and markets are yet to be fully proven. In addition, we are exposed to risks, uncertainties, expenses and difficulties frequently encountered by companies at an early stage of development. Some of these risks and uncertainties relate to our ability to:

    ·   
increase our student enrollment by expanding the type, scope and technical sophistication of the educational services we offer;
    ·
respond effectively to competitive pressures;
    ·
respond in a timely manner to technological changes or resolve unexpected network interruptions;
    ·
comply with changes to regulatory requirements;
    ·
maintain adequate control of our costs and expenses;
    ·
increase awareness of our educational programs; and
    ·
attract and retain qualified management and employees.
 
 
32

 
 
We cannot predict whether we will meet internal or external expectations of our future performance. If we are not successful in addressing these risks and uncertainties, our business, financial condition and results of operations may be materially adversely affected.
 
We could be held legally responsible if we use, without permission, copyrighted materials owned by other parties in connection with the animation and distribution of Institute of Modern Economy products.
 
We believe the copyrights, trademarks, trade secrets and other intellectual property we use in connection with the animation and distribution of Institute of Modern Economy products are important to our business, and any unauthorized use of such intellectual property by third parties may adversely affect our business and reputation. We rely on the intellectual property laws and contractual arrangements with our employees, clients, business partners and others to protect such intellectual property rights. Third parties may be able to obtain and use such intellectual property without authorization. Moreover, litigation may be necessary in the future to enforce our intellectual property rights, which could result in substantial costs and diversion of our resources, and have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may be subject to infringement and misappropriation claims in the future, which may cause us to incur significant expenses, pay substantial damages and be prevented from providing our services.
 
Our success depends, in part, on our ability to carry out our business without infringing the intellectual property rights of third parties. We may be subject to litigation involving claims of copyright or trademark infringement, or other violations of intellectual property rights of third parties. Future litigation may cause us to incur significant expenses, and third-party claims, if successfully asserted against us, may cause us to pay substantial damages, seek licenses from third parties, pay ongoing royalties, redesign our services or technologies, or prevent us from providing services or technologies subject to these claims. Even if we were to prevail, any litigation would likely be costly and time-consuming and divert the attention of our management and key personnel from our business operations.

We could be held accountable for perceived inaccurate information presented in our products.
 
Whyte Lyon delivers on-line educational content to designated end users for distribution and online streaming.  Its content, to be designated and branded as “The Institute of Modern Economy” will consist of seven to twelve minute educational course segments on personal finance management, financial products and other related financial topics.  Under the trademarked name "Institute of Modern Economy" (IOME), educational videos are shot, animated and produced for existing clientele. Customers may either customize specific subject matter for development, or purchase existing material from the IOME catalog. If our customers experience any loss due to the information presented in our courses, lectures, and short lecture videos, we could be held accountable for any perceived inaccurate information presented in such products.

Risks Related to Our Common Stock

Because we became public through a reverse merger, we may not be able to attract the attention of major brokerage firms.
 
Additional risks are associated with us becoming public through a reverse merger. For example, security analysts of major brokerage firms may not provide coverage of us since there is no incentive to brokerage firms to recommend the purchase of our common stock. We cannot assure you that brokerage firms will want to conduct any public offerings on our behalf in the future.
 
Our common stock may be considered a “penny stock” and may be difficult to sell.
 
The Securities and Exchange Commission has adopted regulations which generally define “penny stock” to be an equity security that has a market or exercise price of less than $5.00 per share, subject to specific exemptions. The market price of our common stock has been below $5.00 per share and therefore may be designated as a “penny stock” according to Securities and Exchange Commission rules. This designation requires any broker or dealer selling these securities to disclose certain information concerning the transaction, obtain a written agreement from the purchaser and determine that the purchaser is reasonably suitable to purchase the securities. These rules may restrict the ability of brokers or dealers to sell our common stock and may affect the ability of our stockholders to sell their shares. In addition, since our common stock is quoted on the OTC Bulletin Board, our stockholders may find it difficult to obtain accurate quotations of our common stock and may find few buyers to purchase the stock or a lack of market makers to support the stock price.
 
 
33

 
 
We may engage in additional financing that could lead to dilution of existing stockholders.
 
We have relied on both equity and debt financing to carry on our business to date, which has consisted primarily of development, the negotiation of strategic alliances and marketing activities. Any future financings by us may result in substantial dilution of the holdings of existing stockholders and could have a negative impact on the market price of our common stock. Furthermore, we cannot assure you that such future financings will be possible.
 
 We do not anticipate paying dividends in the foreseeable future; you should not buy our stock if you expect dividends.
 
We currently intend to retain our future earnings to support operations and to finance expansion and, therefore, we do not anticipate paying any cash dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future.

We may be required to record a significant charge to earnings if our intangible assets become impaired.
 
We are required under generally accepted accounting principles to review our intangible assets for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable. Factors that may be considered a change in circumstances indicating that the carrying value of our intangible assets may not be recoverable include, among others, material changes in the actual activity level for our domain name as compared to original expectation and recent transactions with respect to domain names acquired.  We may be required to record a significant charge to earnings in our consolidated financial statements during the period in which any impairment of intangible assets is determined. This could adversely impact our results of operations.


Not applicable.

 
           Our current corporate headquarters are located at 14 Wall Street, 20th floor, New York, NY, 10005.  As of December 31, 2009, the Company does not own or maintain any property plant or equipment of any material nature.  The corporate headquarters were leased on a contractual basis through March 31, 2009 and are now maintained on a month to month basis.
 
We believe that our facilities are adequate to meet our current needs. However, we are presently evaluating the sharing of office space with our subsidiary, Weston Capital Management.  Weston Capital Management has a New York City office located at 767 Third Avenue, New York, New York 10017.
 
Our offices are in good condition and are sufficient to conduct our operations. We do not intend to renovate, improve, or develop properties. We are not subject to competitive conditions for property and currently have no property to insure. We have no policy with respect to investments in real estate or interests in real estate and no policy with respect to investments in real estate mortgages. Further, we have no policy with respect to investments in securities of or interests in persons primarily engaged in real estate activities.

 
As of December 31, 2009, there were no legal actions pending against us, or any subsidiary, or of which our property, or the property of any subsidiary, was subject nor to our knowledge are any such proceedings contemplated.

Our subsidiary, AdvisorShares Investments, LLC is currently not involved in any legal proceedings. 
 
 
34

 
 
Notwithstanding the foregoing, an arbitration proceeding was commenced on November 7, 2008 against Mr. Noah Hamman, the Chief Executive Officer of AdvisorShares, the Company’s majority owned subsidiary, and part owner (“Member”) of Arrow Investment Advisors, LLC (“Arrow”), by Arrow.  The arbitration was commenced pursuant to the provisions of the LLC Operating Agreement of Arrow and brought under the auspices of the International Institute for Conflict Prevention and Resolution in New York, as required under the LLC Operating Agreement. The arbitration involved the other Members of Arrow who asserted an ownership claim regarding Mr. Hamman's ownership interest in AdvisorShares.  Such Members claimed that AdvisorShares’ business is based on the improper usurpation and conversion by Mr. Hamman of Arrow’s corporate opportunities and assets, including the business of AdvisorShares. 

If the other Members of Arrow prevailed on their claims, this would have impacted the amount of ownership Mr. Hamman indirectly holds in AdvisorShares in that Mr. Hamman could have lost his 40% interest in AdvisorShares to Arrow. In addition, if Arrow prevailed, Arrow could have asserted other claims including that the Purchase and Contribution Agreement (to which the Company a party) was inappropriately executed and sought to nullify the obligations associated with such agreement.

On March 1, 2010, Mr. Hamman, Arrow and the Members agreed to settle the Arbitration. In addition, on March 1, 2010, AdvisorShares exchanged general releases with Arrow and the Members pursuant to which Arrow and the Members released AdvisorShares from any claim or contention regarding any right, title, equity, ownership or interest in or to AdvisorShares, its business activities, products or intellectual property.

From time to time, we are a party to litigation or other legal proceedings that we consider to be a part of the ordinary course of our business. We are not involved currently in legal proceedings that could reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, financial condition or results of operations. We may become involved in material legal proceedings in the future.

 
 
35

 
 
PART II

 
Our Class A Common Stock is currently quoted on the OTCBB under the symbol “FNDM” and began trading January 19, 2008. There is a limited trading market for our Class A Common Stock and there is currently no trading market for our Class B common stock.  The following table shows the reported high and low closing bid quotations per share for our common stock based on information provided by the Over-the-Counter Bulletin Board. Particularly since our common stock is traded infrequently, such over-the-counter market quotations reflect inter-dealer prices, without markup, markdown or commissions and may not necessarily represent actual transactions or a liquid trading market.

Year Ended December 31, 2009
 
High
   
Low
 
First Quarter ended March 31, 2009
 
$
3.10
   
$
0.40
 
Second Quarter ended June 30, 2009
 
$
1.95
   
$
0.10
 
Third Quarter ended September 30, 2009
 
$
2.75
   
$
1.30
 
Fourth Quarter ended December 31, 2009
 
$
2.00
   
$
0.63
 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2008
 
High
   
Low
 
First Quarter ended March 31, 2008
 
$
10.05
   
$
1.01
 
Second Quarter ended June 30, 2008
 
$
4.55
   
$
2.80
 
Third Quarter ended September 30, 2008
 
$
4.55
   
$
2.88
 
Fourth Quarter ended December 31, 2008
 
$
3.05
   
$
1.50
 
 
The shares quoted are subject to the provisions of Section 15(g) and Rule 15g-9 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the Exchange Act"), commonly referred to as the "penny stock" rule. Section 15(g) sets forth certain requirements for transactions in penny stocks and Rule 15g-9(d)(1) incorporates the definition of penny stock as that used in Rule 3a51-1 of the Exchange Act.
 
The Commission generally defines penny stock to be any equity security that has a market price less than $5.0 per share, subject to certain exceptions. Rule 3a51-1 provides that any equity security is considered to be a penny stock unless that security is: registered and traded on a national securities exchange meeting specified criteria set by the Commission; authorized for quotation on The NASDAQ Stock Market; issued by a registered investment company; excluded from the definition on the basis of price (at least $5.00 per share) or the registrant's net tangible assets; or exempted from the definition by the Commission. Trading in the shares is subject to additional sales practice requirements on broker-dealers who sell penny stocks to persons other than established customers and accredited investors, generally persons with assets in excess of $1,000,000 or annual income exceeding $200,000, or $300,000 together with their spouse.
 
For transactions covered by these rules, broker-dealers must make a special suitability determination for the purchase of such securities and must have received the purchaser's written consent to the transaction prior to the purchase. Additionally, for any transaction involving a penny stock, unless exempt, the rules require the delivery, prior to the first transaction, of a risk disclosure document relating to the penny stock market. A broker-dealer also must disclose the commissions payable to both the broker-dealer and the registered representative, and current quotations for the securities. Finally, the monthly statements must be sent disclosing recent price information for the penny stocks held in the account and information on the limited market in penny stocks. Consequently, these rules may restrict the ability of broker dealers to trade and/or maintain a market in the company’s common stock and may affect the ability of shareholders to sell their shares.

Number of Shareholders

As of March 31, 2010, 400,000 of our shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock, par value $.001, 69,465,905 shares of our Class A common stock, par value $.001 per share, and 5,462,665 shares of our Class B common stock, par value $.001 per share, were issued and outstanding.  As of March 31, 2010, there were 402 holders of record of our Class A common stock and 2 holders of record of our Class B common stock. The transfer agent of our common stock is Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company, 17 Battery Place, 8th Floor, New York, New York 10004.
 
 
36

 
 
Dividends

Holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends if, as and when declared by the Board of Directors out of funds legally available therefore.  On January 4, 2008, we declared (and subsequently paid) a 900% dividend on our common stock, or nine shares for each share of common stock, to all holders of record on January 15, 2008. We do not expect to pay cash dividends on our common stock, but instead, intend to utilize available cash to support the development and expansion of our business. Any future determination relating to our dividend policy will be made at the discretion of our Board of Directors and will depend on a number of factors, including but not limited to, future operating results, capital requirements, financial condition and the terms of any credit facility or other financing arrangements we may obtain or enter into, future prospects and in other factors our Board of Directors may deem relevant at the time such payment is considered. There is no assurance that we will be able or will desire to pay dividends in the near future or, if dividends are paid, in what amount.

Shares eligible for future sale could depress the price of our common stock, thus lowering the value of a buyer’s investment. Sales of substantial amounts of common stock, or the perception that such sales could occur, could adversely affect prevailing market prices for shares of our common stock.

Our revenues and operating results may fluctuate significantly from quarter to quarter, which can lead to significant volatility in the price and volume of our stock. In addition, stock markets have experienced extreme price and volume volatility in recent years. This volatility has had a substantial effect on the market prices of securities of many smaller public companies for reasons unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of the specific companies. These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the market price of our common stock.

Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans

On December 27, 2007, our Board of Directors approved the Company’s 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for the issuance of up to 5,055,000 shares of our common stock.  The plan was approved by our stockholders on December 27, 2007.   Our board of directors adopted an amendment to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan to increase the number of shares reserved for issuance thereunder to 10,000,000 shares of Class A common stock, which was subsequently approved by a majority of our shareholders by written consent in April 2009. We intend to make all of our equity-based awards on a going-forward basis under the stock incentive plan. The purpose of our stock incentive plan is to attract, retain and motivate officers and other key employees and to provide these persons with incentives and rewards for superior performance and contribution.
 
The plan is administered by the Board of Directors, however the board may delegate any or all of its administrative functions to one or more committees. The board may select plan participants and authorize grants.  The award agreements issued under the stock incentive plan list the exercise price, the conditions and restrictions that must be satisfied for an individual to vest in an award and the term of the award.  The terms of the award agreements may differ from participant to participant, and the board has discretion to accelerate vesting in the event of a change in control or other events.
 
The board may amend, suspend, or terminate the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan at any time and for any reason. If not terminated earlier, the plan will automatically terminate on December 27, 2017.
 
 
37

 
 
Equity Compensation Plan Information

The following table presents information as of December 31, 2009 with respect to compensation plans under which equity securities were authorized for issuance.
 
Plan category
 
Number of securities
to be issued upon
exercise of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
(a)
 
Weighted average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
(b)
 
Number of securities
remaining available for
future issuance under
equity compensation plans
(excluding securities
reflected in column
(a))
(c)
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders
 
5,875,546
 
$2.60
 
4,124,454
               
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders
 
-0-
   
-0-
 
-0-
               
Total
 
5,875,546
  $
2.60
 
4,124,454
 
The equity compensation plans are discussed in Note 6 of the 2009 Consolidated Financial Statements.

Other than as set forth above, we do not have any stock option, bonus, profit sharing, pension or similar plan.

Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers

There were no purchases or repurchases of our equity securities by the Company or any affiliated purchasers.

Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds

During the fourth quarter of 2009, we issued (or contracting to issue) equity securities without registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, as follows:
 
In October 2009, we issued options (the “Options”) to purchase an aggregate of 1,600,000 shares of Class A common stock which was approved by our board of directors on May 14, 2009 under our Amended and Restated 2007 Stock Incentive Plan to the following directors and officers, and in the following amounts, as compensation for services performed and to be performed on behalf of our company:

Grantee
 
Number of Options
 
Gregory Webster
   
750,000
 
Philip Gentile
   
250,000
 
Michael Hlavsa
   
250,000
 
Ivar Eilertsen
   
300,000
 
Raul Biancardi
   
50,000
 
 
             The Options are exercisable at a price of $0.60 per share for a period of 5 years from the date of grant.  The Options vest as follows: (i) 1/3rd on May 14, 2009; (ii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2010; and (iii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2011.
 
In October 2009, we issued 100,000 restricted shares of our Class A common stock to Gregory Webster which was approved by our board of directors on May 14, 2009 under our Amended and Restated 2007 Stock Incentive Plan as compensation for services performed and to be performed on behalf of our company.  In addition, on May 14, 2009 our board of directors approved the issuance of an additional 150,000 restricted shares of our Class A common stock to Gregory Webster as compensation for services performed and to be performed on behalf of our company which vest as follows: (i) 75,000 on May 14, 2010; and (ii) 75,000 on May 14, 2011.  
 
 
38

 
 
On October 14, 2009, the Company entered into an agreement with the stockholders of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., a Delaware corporation, d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy” (“Whyte Lyon”) to acquire 100% of the capital stock of such corporation in exchange for 500,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, which the parties valued at $2.00 per share.  
 
All of the above offerings and sales were deemed to be exempt under rule 506 of Regulation D and Section 4(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. No advertising or general solicitation was employed in offering the securities. The offerings and sales were made to a limited number of persons, all of whom were accredited investors, business associates of Fund.com Inc. or executive officers of Fund.com Inc., and transfer was restricted by Fund.com Inc. in accordance with the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933. In addition to representations by the above-referenced persons, we have made independent determinations that all of the above-referenced persons were accredited or sophisticated investors, and that they were capable of analyzing the merits and risks of their investment, and that they understood the speculative nature of their investment. Furthermore, all of the above-referenced persons were provided with access to our Securities and Exchange Commission filings.
 

Not applicable.


WE URGE YOU TO READ THE FOLLOWING DISCUSSION IN CONJUNCTION WITH OUR CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND THE NOTES THERETO BEGINNING ON PAGE F-1. THIS DISCUSSION MAY CONTAIN FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS THAT INVOLVE SUBSTANTIAL RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES. OUR ACTUAL RESULTS, PERFORMANCE OR ACHIEVEMENTS COULD DIFFER MATERIALLY FROM THOSE EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED BY THE FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS AS A RESULT OF A NUMBER OF FACTORS, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES DISCUSSED UNDER THE HEADING “RISK FACTORS” IN THIS FORM 10-K AND IN OUR OTHER FILINGS WITH THE SEC. IN ADDITION, SEE “CAUTIONARYSTATEMENT REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTSSET FORTH IN THIS REPORT.

Overview

Fund.com Inc. (the “Company,” “we”, “us” or “our”) is a provider of fund management products and risk management solutions that help financial advisors, wealth managers, institutions, and ultra-high-net-worth families create and manage wealth. We also offer services and investment fund information to the mass-market individual investor over the Internet at www.fund.com. As of April 15, 2010, through our subsidiaries, we manage and earn fees on over $1.0 billion in client assets.

Our wealth management business solutions include:

    ·      
ETF Platform. An outsourced platform for launching actively managed exchange traded funds (ETFs) for banks, trust companies, independent wealth advisers, and investment managers who desire to issue and manage ETFs on a white-label basis;
    ·      
Regulatory Authority. Outsourced administration and compliance for ETFs, including the use of specialized regulatory authority granted to us by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) permitting the discretionary active management of assets within an ETF to meet the investment objectives of the ETF and ETF manager;
    ·      
Investment Products. A wealth management business catering to institutional and ultra-high-net-worth clients seeking investment in hedge funds offering a family of hedge fund and fund of funds investment products;
    ·      
Fund Distribution. A 17-year-old established fund distribution business that sells and markets various fund products; and
    ·      
Online Lead Generation. A user friendly website accessible on the Internet through a unique and recognizable top-level domain name that is intended to engage individual investors as an online educational resource and then to match their investment needs with providers of retirement solutions and investment funds, including ETFs.

Through our AdvisorShares Investments LLC subsidiary (“AdvisorShares”), we have developed an investment platform that originates and sells a new investment product known as actively managed exchange traded funds (“ETFs”).  We believe that AdvisorShares is one of limited number of companies that have received an exemption from the SEC to originate, market and sell actively managed ETFs.  AdvisorShares sells such ETF products in conjunction with leading investment managers who are responsible for managing the assets within the ETFs we create.
 
 
39

 
 
As reported by Blackstone Research, as of the end of February 2010, the U.S. ETF market had an aggregate of approximately $764.6 billion in total net assets.  Accordingly, we believe that the ETF market continues to experience rapid growth and represents a widely accepted financial innovation.  

The business of AdvisorShares is to develop a diverse range of "actively managed" ETFs together with established third party asset managers, and to list these ETFs on the New York Stock Exchange, or a similar national or international securities exchange. The target clients of AdvisorShares are third party investment advisors who already manage clients' assets, have a favorable track record and desire to package their investment strategy using exchange-traded funds.  Under our business model, the investment manager acts as a “sub-advisor” to the fund and selects and supervises the investments of its individual ETF.  By accessing the AdvisorShares ETF platform, third party investment managers will be able to establish their own branded, or "white-labeled," ETF on a "turn-key" basis, wherein AdvisorShares is responsible, among other things, for the compliance and administration of the fund.  AdvisorShares and the investment manager share in the fee income, subject to a monthly minimum paid to AdvisorShares.
 
An “actively managed” ETF is not an index fund that seeks to replicate the performance of a specified index.  An actively managed ETF uses an active investment strategy to meet its investment objectives. As a result, each of the investment sub-advisors to AdvisorShares ETFs has discretion on a daily basis to manage the fund’s portfolio in accordance with its stated investment objectives.
 
On March 29, 2010, we consummated the acquisition of 100% of the membership interests of Weston Capital Management, LLC (“Weston Capital”).  Founded in 1993 and headquartered in West Palm Beach, FL, Weston Capital has three lines of business: it originates and markets fund of funds; it originates and markets single-manager hedge funds; and it raises capital to seed new hedge funds.  Weston Capital currently earns fees on assets exceeding $1.0 billion under management.  Its founder Albert Hallac continues as CEO of Weston Capital, directing its day-to-day operations and business strategy, and our Chairman Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of Weston Capital. Weston Capital also has offices in London and New York City.   Management believes with Weston Capital’s operations, when aligned with our majority interest in AdvisorShares, will enable us to accelerate increases of assets under management since we now has the ability to seed, originate and distribute hedge funds as well as seed, originate, develop and distribute actively traded ETFs to institutional and retail investors. 
 
Consistent with our focus of providing financial content, the Company also recently consummated two strategic investments.  They consisted of the acquisition of 100% of the capital stock of Whyte Lyon Socratic Inc., d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy”, a Delaware corporation (“Whyte Lyon”) and an investment in the equity of Vensure Employer Services, Inc., an Arizona corporation (“Vensure”).  Both transactions were consummated on November 2, 2009, but were deemed to be effective as of September 29, 2009.
 
Whyte Lyon is a development stage online provider of financial literacy video content delivered over the Internet. Sometimes referred to as distance learning, such remote educational content is designed to assist on-line students to:

·
 develop the necessary skills to understand financial transactions and financial markets;
·
 develop money management skills to help them manage their income and wealth; and
·
 reach particular goals, including homeownership, debt reconciliation, or improved credit reports.
  
Simultaneous with our acquisition of Whyte Lyon, we purchased an equity interest in Vensure Employer Services, Inc., a professional employer organization, or PEO, located in Mesa, Arizona.  Vensure provides a broad range of services to small and medium-sized businesses, consisting of benefits and payroll administration, health and workers’ compensation insurance programs, personnel records management, employer liability management, employee recruiting and selection, employee performance management, employee training and development services and retirement obligations, including a retirement services product line that offers a variety of options to clients like 401(k) plans, profit sharing, and money purchase plans.

We also publish information online about investment funds at www.fund.com. Our objective is to engage individual investors as an online educational and research resource and then to match their investment needs with fund product providers, including ETFs offered by investment managers that use our ETF platform as well as investment products managed by Weston Capital. We earn investment management fees as both (i) a percentage of assets in our ETFs, which we share with the investment managers, and (ii) a percentage of assets managed by Weston Capital.  We, therefore, have an economic incentive to assist in increasing assets under management through client referrals derived from our online businesses.
 
 
40

 
 
Our plan of operation is to continue the further development of our website. This may include certain capital expenditures for technology, content and database management, including certain online advertising systems and affiliate marketing systems that management believes will assist in executing our customer acquisition business plan. Our website is anticipated to evolve over time as we introduce new content and features and generally seek to improve the customer experience. Our website was launched in March 2009 with the full planned feature set accessible at www.fund.com. We continue to seek strategic relationships that will further enhance the website development and usage.
 
Our principal executive office is located at 14 Wall Street, 20th Floor, New York, New York 10005.  Our telephone number is (212) 618-1633.  We maintain a website at www.fund.com and AdvisorShares maintains a website at www.advisorshares.com.  These websites, and the information contained therein, are not part of this annual report.

Terms of Acquisition of AdvisorShares
 
On October 31, 2008, the Company entered into a Purchase and Contribution Agreement, dated as of October 31, 2008 (the “Purchase and Contribution Agreement”), with AdvisorShares Investments, LLC (“AdvisorShares”), Wilson Lane Group, LLC, and Noah Hamman, the managing member and principal officer of AdvisorShares. Pursuant to the Purchase and Contribution Agreement, the Company purchased 6,000,000 units of AdvisorShares, (representing 60% of the outstanding membership interests of AdvisorShares) for a purchase price of $4,000,000, with an initial contribution of $275,000 and up to an additional $3,725,000 being contributed to AdvisorShares in accordance with the achievement of specific milestones as defined in the Purchase and Contribution Agreement, including (i) $1,000,000 within 30 days of the issuance by the SEC of its notice regarding approval of the application of AdvisorShares for exemptive relief under the Investment Company Act of 1940; (ii) $725,000 within 30 days of receipt by the Company from AdvisorShares’ independent auditors verifying total assets under management equal to $150,000,000; (iii) $1,000,000 within 30 days of receipt by the Company from AdvisorShares’ independent auditors verifying total assets under management equal to $250,000,000; and (iv) $1,000,000 within 30 days of receipt by the Company from AdvisorShares’ independent auditors verifying total assets under management equal to $450,000,000.  In connection with our acquisition of 60% of the equity interests in AdvisorShares, we entered into an Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of AdvisorShares, dated as of October 31, 2008 (the “LLC Agreement”), and was admitted as a member of AdvisorShares. 

AdvisorShares and AdvisorShares Trust, a Delaware open-end investment management company (the “Trust”) that was recently formed by AdvisorShares for the purpose of offering a series of exchange traded funds (the “Funds”), filed an application with the SEC under the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the “Investment Company Act”) on January 31, 2008, as amended on October 17, 2008. The application requests an order from the SEC, exempting AdvisorShares and the Trust from the provisions of the Investment Company Act and permitting (a) the issuance of series of open-ended management investment companies to issue shares redeemable in large aggregations only, (b) engaging in secondary market transactions in Shares at negotiated market prices; and (c) certain affiliated persons of the series to deposit securities into, and receive securities from, the series in connection with the purchase and redemption of the creation units (the “Exemption Order”).

 On December 23, 2008, the SEC issued a notice advising that it would issue a final order granting the requested relief unless it orders a hearing on the application based on requests for a hearing given by third parties by not later than January 15, 2009.  A third party timely filed a hearing request involving an intellectual property dispute which AdvisorShares believes is unrelated to the merits of the application.  On July 20, 2009, the SEC agreed with AdvisorShares’ position and issued the final Exemptive Order approving the application.  AdvisorShares received a copy of the final Exemptive Order on July 21, 2009.
 
On August 18, 2009, the Company consummated payment in full of the $1,000,000 due to AdvisorShares for achieving the first milestone under the Agreement. The funding was provided to the Company by IP Global and Equities Media, a principal stockholder of the Company, under the amended and restated $2.5 million line of credit facility described herein. The Company currently owns 60% of the outstanding units of AdvisorShares after the initial contributions of $1,275,000 by the Company. The Company will maintain its ownership of 60% of the outstanding units of AdvisorShares irrespective of AdvisorShares achieving any additional milestones.
 
 
41

 
 
The Company does not currently have the capital or resources to make the additional $2,725,000 in payments to AdvisorShares following AdvisorShares’ achievement of the remaining milestones.  In order to obtain funds to satisfy the remaining payment obligations to AdvisorShares (assuming the remaining milestones are achieved), we may utilize any of several potential options, including cash on hand from operating results, the issuance of debt or equity securities, or a combination thereof.  No assurance can be given that we will have available cash on hand from operating results or be able to obtain additional financing on favorable terms, if at all.  Moreover, the Company cannot predict with certainty if and when the remaining milestones for total assets under management will be met by AdvisorShares. 

Terms of Acquisition of Weston Capital Management, LLC
 
On March 29, 2010, the Company consummated the acquisition (the “Acquisition”) of Weston Capital Management, LLC (“Weston Capital”), pursuant to a Securities Purchase and Restructuring Agreement dated as of March 26, 2010 (the “Purchase Agreement”) by and among the Company, Weston Capital, PBC-Weston Capital Holdings, LLC (“PBC”), Albert Hallac (“A. Hallac”) and the other persons who are parties signatory thereto (together with PBC and A. Hallac, the “Members”).
 
Pursuant to a newly executed long-term Employment Agreement, Weston Capital founder Albert Hallac continues as CEO of Weston Capital and a member of its board of managers and will direct Weston Capital’s day-to-day operations and business strategy.  In addition, Fund.com Chairman Joseph J. Bianco joined as Chairman of the Board of Weston Capital.

Under the Purchase Agreement:

·   the Company acquired from all of the Members, an aggregate of 100% of the membership interests in Weston Capital (the “Membership Interests”) for total consideration of $9,600,000 plus $1,500,000 in warrants described below, including:
 
(i) 25% of the issued and outstanding Membership Interests purchased by PBC on or about June 5, 2006 (the “PBC Member Interests”), in consideration for the payment of $2,500,000 in cash and delivery of the “Warrant” described below; and

(ii) the remaining 75% of the issued and outstanding Membership Interests (the “Hallac Interests”) owned by Albert. Hallac, certain members of his family, and Victor Elmaleh (collectively, the “Hallac Members”), in consideration for the payment of $5,500,000, consisting of $500,000 in cash and delivery of the Company’s 4% $5,000,000 senior secured adjustable principal amount note due March 31, 2015 (the “Reset Note”);
 
·   in addition to its purchase of 100% of the Membership Interests, the Company made an additional cash capital contribution to Weston Capital in the aggregate amount of $800,000 in order to fund the integration of Weston Capital and the AdvisorShares ETF business and for general working capital. The contribution was made in exchange for 9.1% of all issued and outstanding Membership Interests in Weston Capital (the “Additional Purchased Membership Interests”); and

·   the Company acquired the right and option, following the satisfaction of applicable regulatory approvals, to purchase 100% of the membership interests of Weston Capital’s broker-dealer subsidiary, Weston Capital Financial Services, LLC (the “Broker Subsidiary”) for nominal additional consideration.
 
In exchange for all of the Membership Interests in Weston Capital, the Company provided the following consideration to the Members:

·   cash payments equal to (i) $2,500,000 to PBC in exchange for the PBC Member Interests; (ii) $800,000 as a capital contribution to Weston Capital; and (iii) $500,000 to Albert Hallac;

·   a Class A common stock purchase warrant (the “Warrant”) to PBC entitling PBC to purchase, beginning September 29, 2010 (the “Six Month Anniversary Date”) through September 30, 2014, such number of shares of Class A common stock of the Company as shall be determined by dividing (A) $1,500,000, by (B) the volume weighted average price of the common stock for the 20 trading days immediately prior to the Six Month Anniversary Date; and
 
·   the Reset Note to Albert Hallac and the other Hallac Members.
 
 
42

 

 
The Company is required to make an installment payment to the holders of the Reset Note in the amount of $2,450,000 on or before May 31, 2010 (the “Installment Payment”).
 
The remaining principal amount of the Reset Note is subject to adjustment on each of March 31, 2013, 2014 and 2015 (each, a “Reset Date”) in such greater or lesser amount equal to the holders’ aggregate percentage interests in the then fair market value of Weston Capital. Such fair market value is to be determined based upon an independent business appraisal.  In addition, commencing on the first Reset Date and at any time on each subsequent Reset Date, the majority of the holders aggregate percentage interest in the Reset Note shall have the right to require that all or a portion of the then outstanding principal amount of the Reset Note (as adjusted based upon such fair market value appraisal) be prepaid by the Company (a “Mandatory Prepayment”), in an amount equal to the product of multiplying (i) the then applicable holders aggregate percentage interest being prepaid and converted, by (ii) the fair market value of 100% of the membership interests in Weston Capital as at the applicable Reset Date (the “Prepayment and Conversion Amount”).  Such Prepayment and Conversion Amount shall be paid by the Company no later than 20 business days following the date of calculation of the applicable Prepayment and Conversion Amount as follows (A) 25% in cash; and (B) 75% (the “Prepayment Balance”) in such number of shares of Class A common stock as shall be equal to the quotient resulting from dividing the Prepayment Balance, by 90% of the volume weighted average price of the Class A common stock for the 20 trading days prior to the applicable Reset Date.  In the event that Albert Hallac is no longer employed by Weston Capital due to his death, resignation or termination for cause, the Company shall have the right, at the Company’s Option exercised within 90 days thereafter, to prepay and convert all of the Reset Note as set forth above (an “Optional Prepayment”).

The Company’s obligation to pay the Installment Payment, when due, and comply with its other obligations under the Reset Note is secured by a pledge by the Company of 50.9% of the Membership Interests in Weston Capital owned by the Hallac Members immediately prior to the closing date pursuant to a certain pledge agreement (the “Pledge Agreement”).
 
Under the terms of the Reset Note, for so long as the Company’s obligations under the Reset Note remain outstanding, the approval or consent of the holders of a majority in interest of the Reset Note or Albert Hallac is required to effect certain major transactions, including:

    ·   
changes to Weston Capital’s Operating Agreement;
    ·   
any change in the fundamental nature of the business of Weston Capital;
    ·   
any material deviation from any permitted fund investments of Weston Capital;
    ·   
the dissolution, merger or consolidation of Weston Capital or a sale of control of Weston Capital;
    ·   
the issuance of any new Members Interests or the admission of new members in Weston Capital;
    ·   
the making of any cash distributions from Weston Capital to the Company unless 50.9% of each such distribution is paid in cash to the Hallac Members;
    ·   
the termination of the management and employment agreements with Jeffrey Hallac, Keith Wellner and Marcel Herbst for any reason other than their death, permanent disability or for Cause, as defined therein; and
    ·   
entering into any related party transaction with the Company or any of its affiliates.
 
The Company financed its cash payments for the Weston Capital acquisition through a series of private placements of its shares and from an advance under its August 2009 loan agreement with IP Global Investors Ltd.

On February 10, 2010, COS Capital Partners I, LLC purchased 9,047,619 Class A common stock of the Company for $1,900,000.  On March 1, 2010, LH Capital Partners LLC purchased 952,381 shares of Class A Common Stock for $200,000.  In March 2010, Recovery Capital purchased 1,080,952 shares of Class A Common Stock for $227,000.  Neither COS Capital Partners, LH Capital Partners nor Recovery Capital are affiliated with the Company or IP Global.

On March 8, 2010, IP Global converted a portion of the principal amount of the then outstanding amount due under a Company Note payable to IP Global into 3,600,000 shares of Class A Common Stock which it sold to an unaffiliated third party for $1,300,000.  Pursuant to its existing August 28, 2009 loan agreement with the Company, effective as of March 29, 2010, IP Global advanced an additional $1,300,000 to the Company to assist the Company in financing its acquisition of Weston Capital.  Such additional advance increased the outstanding amount due to IP Global under the Company’s August 2009 loan Agreement from $730,750 to $2,030,750.  Such loan is due and payable on December 31, 2011.
 
 
43

 
 
Terms of Investment in Vensure Employer Services, Inc.
 
On September 24, 2009, we and Vensure Employer Services, Inc. (“Vensure”) entered into a securities purchase agreement (the “Vensure Purchase Agreement”). Consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement occurred on November 2, 2009; provided, that for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments were deemed to have occurred effective at 5:00 p.m. on September 29, 2009.
 
Under the terms of the Vensure Purchase Agreement, we agreed to sell and assign to Vensure, our right to receive payments under the original $20.0 million certificate of deposit issued in November 2007 by Global Bank in exchange for consideration consisting of (a) 218,883.33 shares of Series A participating convertible preferred stock of Vensure (the “Series A Preferred Stock”), and (b) a seven year content agreement (the “Content Agreement”) among Vensure, Vensure Retirement Administration, Inc., a whole owned subsidiary of Vensure, our company and Whyte Lyon. In October 2009, we were orally advised by Global Bank of its intention to elect to exercise its contractual rights to exchange and swap its obligations under the certificate of deposit for a ten year 5.0% annuity contract issued by a third party.  We notified Vensure of the banks election (which was subsequently confirmed in writing), and on November 2, 2009 Vensure agreed to accept such annuity contract in lieu of the certificate of deposit.

The Vensure Series A Preferred Stock:

    ·   
has a liquidation value of $100 per share or $21,888,333 as to all 218,883.33 shares;
    ·   
is senior to all other capital stock of Vensure;
    ·   
pays dividends as and when declared by the board of directors of Vensure on its common stock;
    ·   
on a “sale of control” (as defined) of Vensure to any unaffiliated third party, in addition to receipt of the first $21,888,333 of consideration payable in respect of Vensure capital stock, participates with the holders of the common stock to the extent of 25% of all additional consideration paid or payable in excess of the maximum $21,888,333 liquidation value of the Series A Preferred; and
    ·   
is convertible at any time after September 30, 2012 upon 61 days prior notice to Vensure into either 25% of the common stock of Vensure; provided, that the board of directors of Vensure may (subject to the Series A Preferred stockholder’s right to rescind its conversion notice) require that the shares of Series A Preferred Stock convert into a maximum of 49.5% of the capital stock of Vensure Retirement Administration, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Vensure.
 
Under the terms of a related stockholders agreement among the Company, Vensure and the Vensure stockholders, the Company is entitled to designate two members of the board of directors of Vensure. The stockholders agreement also contains customary buy/sell and related provisions in the event of sales of any shares of Vensure.  The Series A Preferred Stock also contains certain protective provisions that requires the approval of the Company or its designees on the board of directors of Vensure before Vensure may implement or commit to certain actions, including:

    ·   
the issuance of securities senior to or on a par with the Series A Preferred Stock;
    ·   
the issuance of any additional capital stock of Vensure;
    ·   
any change it’s the fundamental nature of its business;
    ·   
the acquisition of the assets or securities of other parties; or
    ·   
the sale or pledge of substantial assets; or
    ·   
any material changes in compensation of senior executive officers.
 
In addition to its receipt of the Series A Preferred Stock, the Company has received the benefits of the Content Agreement.  Under the terms of the Content Agreement, the Company and Whyte Lyon will provide all existing and future employees, co-employees and other associates (collectively, the “End Users”) of Vensure, its subsidiaries and affiliates, as well as Vensure clients (collectively, the “Vensure Group”) with access to on-line educational content to be streamed to such End-Users from the website(s) of the Vensure Group.  Such Content, to be designated and branded as “Vensure University,” “The Money School” or other brand name acceptable to the parties to the Content Agreement, will include up to 84 five to seven minute educational course segments on personal finance management, financial products and other related financial topics as are approved by Vensure and the Company.  Course segments may also include safety training, health care and other topics of interest to workers and the work place.
 
 
44

 
 
In consideration for providing the Content, the Vensure Group is required to pay the Company and its Whyte Lyon subsidiary an access fee of $19.95 per month (the “Monthly Access Fee”) for each End-User who has access to the Content from the website(s) of the Vensure Group, whether or not such End-User actually clicks on such website and views the Content.  Based on the current Vensure employment complement of approximately 4,000 employees or co-employees, this represents approximately $80,000 a month in anticipated revenues to the Company from such Monthly Access Fee as soon as the initial Content is provided.  The Company and its subsidiary have agreed to deliver approximately three course segments during each calendar quarter commencing with the quarter ending March 31, 2010 and ending December 31, 2016. Following October 2012, the $19.95 Monthly Access Fee is subject to renegotiation at the option of Vensure.
 
Our board of directors considered a number of factors in exercising its business judgment to consummate the investment in Vensure, including, among other things, the likelihood that the Global Bank certificate of deposit would not be paid on its November 2010 maturity date as was disclosed as a potential risk in the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 17, 2008. In addition, the Company considered the potential lack of liquidity arising from the proposed exchange for a long-term investment instrument.

Terms of Acquisition of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc.
 
On October 14, 2009, the Company entered into an agreement with the stockholders of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., a Delaware corporation, d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy” (“Whyte Lyon”) to acquire 100% of the capital stock of such corporation in exchange for 500,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, which the parties valued at $2.00 per share.  Closing of the acquisition of the shares of Whyte Lyon occurred on November 2, 2009 following consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement.  However, for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments in connection with the Whyte Lyon acquisition and the Vensure investment were deemed to have occurred effective on September 29, 2009.  Upon completion of the Company’s acquisition of Whyte Lyon, its principal stockholder, Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Company.

Critical Accounting Policies
 
Our discussion and analysis of results of operations and financial condition are based upon our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and related disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.
 
The Company considered the quality and variability of information regarding the financial condition and operating performance that may have changed in the past and future that may have a material effect and has quantified them where possible. Specifically, the Company considers risk of variability with changes in contract which may affect the recognition of income and also the possibility of changes in the tax code which may affect the long term rates of return.
 
Our significant accounting policies are as follows:

Basis of Presentation
 
The Company has not produced any significant revenue from its principal business and is a development stage company as defined by the Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 915 Development Stage Entities.

Principles of Consolidation
 
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Fund.com Inc. and its subsidiaries.  All material intercompany accounts and transactions are eliminated in consolidation. The year end for the Company and its subsidiaries is December 31.  Certain reclassifications have been made in the 2008 results to conform to the presentation used in 2009.

Use of Estimates
 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements.  These estimates and assumptions also affect the reported amounts of revenues, costs and expenses during the reporting period.  Management evaluates these estimates and assumptions on a regular basis.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
 
45

 
 
Revenue Recognition
 
The Company recognizes revenue in accordance with ASC 605 Revenue Recognition which established that revenue can be recognized when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, the product has been shipped, all significant contractual obligations have been satisfied and collection is reasonably assured.

Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
The Company considers all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents.  Cash and cash equivalents are defined to include cash on hand and cash in the bank.

Certificate of Deposit
 
On November 9, 2007, the Company deposited $20,000,000 into a fixed Certificate of Deposit with an interest rate of 5.00% per annum payable at maturity, for a term of three years.  Accrued interest of $750,000 and $1,000,000 has been recorded for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Pursuant to a securities purchase agreement dated September 24, 2009 which the Company entered into with Vensure Employer Services, Inc., the rights were assigned to receive payments under the Certificate of Deposit to Vensure, effective as of September 29, 2009 for certain consideration.  In October 2009, prior to the closing of the Vensure transaction, Global Bank of Commerce advised the Company of its intention to exercise its contractual rights to exchange the Certificate of Deposit for an annuity contract issued by a third party, and on November 2, 2009 Vensure agreed to accept such annuity contract in lieu of the certificate of deposit.

Investments
 
The Company’s investment portfolio consists of equity securities and certain other investments classified as available for sale. All investments are initially recorded at cost.  In accordance with ASC 820 Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures, investments are remeasured at their fair value at each reporting period.
 
The Company’s policy for the evaluation of temporarily impaired securities to determine whether the impairment is other-than temporary is based on analysis of the following factors: (1) rating downgrade or other credit event (e.g., failure to pay interest when due); (2) financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer or non-issuer, including any specific events which may influence the operations of the issuer or non-issuer such as changes in technology or discontinuance of a business segment; (3) prospects for the issuer’s or non-issuer’s industry segment; and (4) intent and ability of the Company to retain the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for anticipated recovery in fair value. The Company evaluates its investments in securities to determine other than temporary impairment, no less than quarterly. Investments that are deemed other than temporarily impaired are written down to their estimated net fair value and the related losses are recognized in operations.

After the Company’s review of its investment portfolio in relation to the above policy, there were no permanently impaired investments noted during the years ended December 31, 2009.   

 Advertising Costs

All advertising costs are charged to expense as incurred. There was no material advertising expense for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.

Research and Development

The Company does not engage in research and development as defined in ASC Topic 730, “Accounting for Research and Development Costs.”  However, the Company does incur costs including salaries and consulting fees related to its website.  These costs are included in Operating Expense in the Statement of Operations.
 
 
46

 
 
Property and Equipment
 
Property and equipment is recorded at cost and depreciated over the estimated useful lives of the assets using principally the straight-line method. When items are retired or otherwise disposed of, income is charged or credited for the difference between net book value and proceeds realized thereon.  Ordinary maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred, and replacements and betterments are capitalized.  The range of estimated useful lives to be used to calculate depreciation for principal items of property and equipment are as follow:
 
Asset Category
 
Depreciation/ Amortization Period
Furniture and Fixture
 
  3 Years
Office equipment
 
  3 Years
Leasehold improvements
 
  5 Years
 
Income Taxes
 
Deferred income taxes are recognized based on the provisions of ASC Topic 740 Income Taxes for the tax consequences in future years of differences between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their financial reporting amounts based on enacted tax laws and statutory tax rates applicable to the periods in which the differences are expected to affect taxable income. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized.
 
In July 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued guidance codified in Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 740-10-25 “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes”. ASC Topic 740-10-25 supersedes guidance codified in ASC Topic 450, “Accounting for Contingencies”, as it relates to income tax liabilities and lowers the minimum threshold a tax position is required to meet before being recognized in the financial statements from “probable” to “more likely than not” (i.e., a likelihood of occurrence greater than fifty percent). Under ASC Topic 740-10-25, the recognition threshold is met when an entity concludes that a tax position, based solely on its technical merits, is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority. Those tax positions failing to qualify for initial recognition are recognized in the first interim period in which they meet the more likely than not standard, or are resolved through negotiation or litigation with the taxing authority, or upon expiration of the statute of limitations. De-recognition of a tax position that was previously recognized occurs when an entity subsequently determines that a tax position no longer meets the more likely than not threshold of being sustained.
 
The Company is subject to ongoing tax exposures, examinations and assessments in various jurisdictions. Accordingly, the Company may incur additional tax expense based upon the outcomes of such matters. In addition, when applicable, the Company will adjust tax expense to reflect the Company’s ongoing assessments of such matters which require judgment and can materially increase or decrease its effective rate as well as impact operating results.
 
Under ASC Topic 740-10-25, only the portion of the liability that is expected to be paid within one year is classified as a current liability. As a result, liabilities expected to be resolved without the payment of cash (e.g. resolution due to the expiration of the statute of limitations) or are not expected to be paid within one year are not classified as current. The Company has recently adopted a policy of recording estimated interest and penalties as income tax expense and tax credits as a reduction in income tax expense.
 
Fund and certain of its subsidiaries (FOT, FMP and FC) did not file federal and applicable state income tax returns for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and prior. Although the Company is incurring losses since its inception, the Company is obligated to file income tax returns for compliance with IRS regulations and that of applicable state jurisdictions. Management believes that the Company will not incur significant penalty and interest for non-filing of federal and state income tax returns, as well as, federal and state income tax liabilities, as applicable, for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and prior considering its loss making history since inception. The Company is still in the process of determining the amount of net taxable operating losses eligible to be carried forward for federal and applicable state income tax purposes for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and prior. The Company is still in the process of determining whether to file a consolidated tax return or a separate tax return for a holding company and its subsidiaries. The Company has not made any provision for federal and state income tax liabilities that may result from this uncertainty as of December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Management believes that this will not have a material adverse impact on the Company’s financial position, its results of operations and its cash flows.
 
 
47

 
 
AdvisorShares and WLS are in compliance with filing of the federal and applicable state income tax returns up until December 31, 2008.
 
The number of years with open tax audits varies depending on the tax jurisdiction. The Company’s major taxing jurisdictions include the United States (including applicable states).

Earnings Per Share         
 
The Company computes basic and diluted earnings per share amounts in accordance with ASC Topic 260, Earnings per Share. Basic earnings per share is computed by dividing net income (loss) available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the reporting period. Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur if stock options and other commitments to issue common stock were exercised or equity awards vest resulting in the issuance of common stock that could share in the earnings of the Company. Common shareholders include both Class A and Class B as the holders of Class A common stock shall be entitled to receive, on a pari passu basis with the holders of Class B common stock, if, as and when declared from time to time by the Board of Directors out of any assets of the Company legally available therefore, such dividends as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments
 
The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount at which the instrument could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties other than in a forced sale or liquidation.   The carrying amounts of financial instruments, including cash, accounts payable and accrued expenses approximate fair value because of the relatively short maturity of the instruments.

Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets
 
The long-lived assets held and used by the Company are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of assets may not be recoverable. It is reasonably possible that these assets could become impaired as a result of technology or other industry changes. Determination of recoverability of assets to be held and used is by comparing the carrying amount of an asset to future net undiscounted cash flows to be generated by the assets. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of assets exceeds the fair value of the assets. Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.
 
The Company tests annually the carrying value of its intangible assets for impairment in accordance with ASC Topic 350 Intangibles – Goodwill and Other and also ASC Topic 360-10-35 Subsequent Measurement.  

Stock-Based Compensation
 
The Company accounts for stock-based compensation in accordance with ASC 718 Compensation – Stock Compensation. The ASC provides that instruments that were originally issued as employee compensation and then modified, and that modification is made to the terms of the instrument solely to reflect an equity restructuring that occurs when the holders are no longer employees, then no change in the recognition or the measurement (due to a change in classification) of those instruments will result if both of the following conditions are met: (a) there is no increase in fair value of the award (or the ratio of intrinsic value to the exercise price of the award is preserved, that is, the holder is made whole), or the antidilution provision is not added to the terms of the award in contemplation of an equity restructuring; and (b) all holders of the same class of equity instruments (for example, stock options) are treated in the same manner.

Results of Operations

The following tables show the results of operations of our business.
 
 
48

 
 
Comparison of the year ended December 31, 2009 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2008
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
2009
   
2008
 
Sales
 
$
279,006
   
$
-
 
Cost of Sales
 
$
-
   
$
-
 
Total Expenses
 
$
5,509,113
   
$
4,551,545
 
Other income (expense)
 
$
(1,347,955)
   
$
1,002,775
 
Income taxes
 
$
-
   
$
-
 
Net income (loss)
 
$
(6,173,533)
   
$
(3,472,250)
 

Results of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008

We reported a net loss of $6,173,533 and $3,472,250 for the years ending December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Until we implement our business plan, we will not have material operating revenues.
 
For the year ending December 31, 2009, we incurred $5,509,113 in operating costs.  This amount includes $2,149,488 related to compensation expense for stock options, $770,518 related to legal and professional fees, $1,293,715 related to payroll and benefits for the officers of the Company, and $632,279 for consulting expenses.
 
For the year ending December 31, 2008, we incurred $4,551,545 in operating costs.  This amount includes $1,880,967 related to compensation expense for stock options, $669,136 related to legal and professional fees, $842,686 related to payroll and benefits for the officers of the Company, and $896,544 for consulting expenses.

As of December 31, 2009, the Company tested the intangible assets for impairment and determined that an impairment charge of $1,794,500 was necessary.  There was no impairment charge recorded in 2008.
 
The $20 million certificate of deposit with the Global Bank of Commerce (an Antiguan bank), held by our wholly-owed subsidiary Fund.com Capital Inc., earned interest of $750,000 and $1,000,000 for years ending December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
On December 31, 2009, the Company had cash of $268,864 and a working capital deficit of approximately $1,787,909.  We will require additional funding in order to meet operating expenses and our development plan.

We were originally incorporated as Eastern Services Holdings, Inc.  In January 15, 2008 we merged with Meade Technologies Inc., following which we changed our corporate name to Fund.com Inc.  In each case, before giving effect to the 9-for-1 dividend on our Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock, in November 2007, we sold an aggregate of 10,350,000 shares of our common stock to eight accredited investors in a private placement at a price of $2.00 per share and received gross proceeds of $20,700,000, and we sold 5,000,000 shares of our common stock and 2,500,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock to an accredited investor and received gross proceeds of $10,000,000.  Substantially all of the proceeds from the sale of the Series A Preferred Stock transaction were used to acquire the domain name www.fund.com.

Following the merger, we had authorized a total of 110,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of which 100,000,000 shares were authorized as Class A Common Stock, 10,000,000 shares were authorized as Class B Common Stock.  In addition, 10,000,000 shares were authorized as Preferred Stock.  
 
On September 2, 2009, the Company amended and restated its certificate of incorporation to increase its authorized capital stock from 120,000,000 shares to 320,000,000 shares, of which 300,000,000 shares are designated as Class A common stock, 10,000,000 shares are designated as Class B common stock and 10,000,000 shares are designated as preferred stock.  Each share of Class A common stock has one vote.  Each share of Class B common stock has 10 votes, votes together with the Class A common stock, and is convertible by the holder at any time upon 61 days prior written notice, which notice may be waived by the Company, into ten shares of Class A common stock.  The authorized shares of preferred stock may be issued by the board of directors from time to time in one or more series and the board of directors has the authority to fix the powers, designations rights, preferences and limitations of any class or series of such preferred stock.

As at December 31, 2009, 46,115,905 shares of Class A Common Stock were outstanding, 6,387,665 shares of Class B Common Stock were outstanding and no shares of Preferred Stock were outstanding.  As of March 31, 2010, 69,465,905 shares of Class A Common Stock were outstanding, 5,462,665 shares of Class B Common Stock were outstanding and 400,000 shares of Preferred Stock were outstanding.
 
 
49

 
 
Working Capital Loan
 
For the past twelve months we have relied on loans and advances from IP Global Investors Ltd., a privately owned intellectual property finance company, to provide us with working capital to pay our operating expenses.
 
Effective as of August 28, 2009, the Company, and IP Global consummated transactions under a line of credit agreement pursuant to which IP Global provided the Company with a $2,500,000 line of credit facility which superseded and restated in its entirety a prior $1.343 million credit agreement with IP Global entered into as of May 1, 2009.  Under the terms of the restated line of credit agreement (which was negotiated and agreed upon in early July 2009), the Company was entitled to receive a maximum of $2,500,000 of advances, less an aggregate of $723,000 of advances made through May 1, 2009 (including the $1,275,000 paid to AdvisorShares on behalf of the Company through August 18, 2009 and an additional $150,000 of advances funded through August 28, 2009).  As of December 31, 2009, the Company has borrowed an aggregate of approximately $2,466,444 under the line of credit, including $1,275,000 paid to AdvisorShares on behalf of the Company.  All obligations under the line of credit agreement have been guaranteed by Fund.com Capital Inc., Fund.com Technologies Inc. and Fund.com Managed Products Inc., all wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company.
 
The advances made under the line of credit agreement are evidenced by the Company’s 9% convertible note due August 28, 2010 (one year from the Closing Date).   The note is convertible at any time prior to its maturity date, at a conversion price of $0.21 per share into shares of Class B common stock of the Company. The conversion price was established based on the public price of Fund.com at the time the parties reached agreement, the price being based on a quantitative formula equal to 90% of the volume weighted average price (VWAP) of the Fund.com stock price as quoted on the OTC Bulletin Board for the thirty days prior to July 6, 2009.
  
As a further inducement to the lender to make available the line of credit, Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann, two shareholders of the Company and members of the board of directors at the time, also sold to the lenders or their designees (in equal amounts) a total of 2,000,000 of their shares of Class A common stock of the Company at a price of $0.25 per share, payable on the basis of $50,000 in cash and the $450,000 balance evidenced by two notes of $225,000 each payable in equal monthly installments through December 31, 2009.  In addition, Messrs. Klaus and Mann each contributed 500,000 of their Company shares to the lender, or its designees, for no consideration, and granted the lender or its designees an option, exercisable at any time up to December 31, 2009, to purchase an additional 2,000,000 of their Class A shares for $0.25 per share. Effective August 28, 2009, Messrs. Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann terminated their consulting agreements with the Company and resigned as members of the board of directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. There was no disagreement or dispute between Messrs. Klaus and Mann and the Company which led to their resignation as directors. They also agreed not to sell their remaining shares in the Company for a period of at least six months.
 
On January 18, 2010, the board of directors of the Company approved the terms of an agreement (the “Debt Restructuring Agreement”) with IP Global and other third party assignees of a portion of a portion of the Note, dated as of December 28, 2009. Under the terms of the Debt Restructuring Agreement, (a) the lender agreed to waive all prior defaults under the Note and Loan Agreement, (b) the lender and certain third party assignees who purchased from IP Global $184,800 principal amount of the Note agreed to convert an aggregate of $840,000 or 33.6% of the Note into 400,000 shares of the Company’s newly authorized Series A preferred stock; (c) the lender sold an additional $509,250 principal amount of the Note to third parties who have agreed to convert such assigned notes into shares of the Company’s Class A Common Stock, (d) the lender agreed (i) to extend the final maturity date of the remaining $1,150,750 outstanding balance of the Note to December 31, 2011, and (ii) not convert more than 25% of such Note balance into Class A Common Stock prior to December 31, 2011.
 
The Company’s Series A Preferred Stock does not pay a dividend, has a stated value of $100 per share, and is convertible, upon not less than 90 days prior written notice to the Company, into Class A Common Stock of the Company at a conversion price of $1.50 per share. At the December 28, 2009 effective date of the Debt Restructuring Agreement, the average closing market prices of the Company’s Class A Common Stock, as traded on the FINRA over-the-counter Bulletin Board was approximately $0.91 per share.
 
 
50

 
 
As part of the transactions contemplated by the line of credit agreement, the lender or its designees received an option (expiring December 31, 2009) to purchase up to $5,000,000 of additional shares of Class A common stock of the Company at a price of $0.21 per share, or approximately 23.8 million shares of Class A common stock if such purchase option is fully exercised. The price was also established on the same VWAP calculation. The Company is not obligated to register the option shares for resale with the SEC. In addition, the Company issued to IP Global a warrant, expiring July 31, 2012, entitling the holder(s) to purchase an aggregate of 50% of the number of shares of Class A common stock that are purchased upon full or partial exercise of the above purchase option, at an exercise price of $0.315 per share.  The exercise prices of the purchase option and the warrant are both subject to certain adjustments, including weighted average anti-dilution adjustments.

IP Global subsequently assigned the option to Recovery Capital, Inc. or its designees (“Recovery Capital”), and Recovery Capital thereafter assigned all or a portion of the option to Huntley Family Investments, LLC or is designees (the “Huntley Group”). The Huntley Group is affiliated with Mars Hill Partners, LLC, the sub-advisor to the Mars Hill Global Relative Value Advisorshare ETF, an actively managed exchange traded fund sponsored by AdvisorShares.  Neither Recovery Capital nor the Huntley Group is affiliated with either the Company or IP Global.

On January 25, 2010, the Company agreed to extend the option period to February 15, 2010, and the Huntley Group exercised the option and agreed to purchase all or a portion of the option shares.  To the extent not fully exercised by the Huntley Group, Recovery Capital retained the right to exercise the remaining portion of the option.  All proceeds received by the Company from the Huntley Group were to be used exclusively to provide financing to enable the Company to consummate its equity investment in Weston Capital Management LLC.

On February 10, 2010, COS Capital Partners I, LLC purchased 9,047,619 Class A common stock of the Company for $1,900,000.  On March 1, 2010, LH Capital Partners LLC purchased 952,381 shares of Class A Common Stock for $200,000.  In March 2010, Recovery Capital purchased 1,080,952 shares of Class A Common Stock for $227,000.  Neither COS Capital Partners, LH Capital Partners nor Recovery Capital is affiliated with either the Company or IP Global.

On February 12, 2010, the Company agreed to further extend the Option Period to February 28, 2010.  In addition, on February 22, 2010, the Company agreed to extend the option period to March 26, 2010 and on March 26 2010, the Company agreed to extend the option to April 30, 2010.
 
On March 8, 2010, IP Global converted a portion of the principal amount of the then outstanding amount due under a Company Note payable to IP Global into 3,600,000 shares of Class A Common Stock which it sold to an unaffiliated third party for $1,300,000.  Pursuant to its August 29, 2010 line of credit loan agreement with the Company, IP Global advanced an additional $1,300,000 to the Company on March 29, 2010 to assist the Company in financing its acquisition of Weston Capital.  Such additional advance increased the then outstanding amount due to IP Global under the Company’s line of credit loan agreement from $730,750 to $2,030,750.  Such loan is due and payable on December 31, 2011. However, to date, the Company has been unable to pay accrued interest and fees to the lenders under the Loan Agreement.
 
As at March 31, 2010, an aggregate of $2,108,122 of indebtedness is outstanding under the line of credit loan agreement, including $2,030,750 in principal amount of the convertible note and an aggregate of $77,372 in unpaid accrued interest and fees.
 
Certificate of Deposit from Global Bank of Commerce
 
On November 9, 2007, Meade Capital, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of Meade Technologies Inc. (both privately owned companies not affiliated with our Company at that time), invested in a $20,000,000 three-year Certificate of Deposit issued by an Antigua bank, the Global Bank of Commerce (“Global Bank”). Global Bank is an affiliate of one of our stockholders (GBC Wealth Management Limited).  This investment was made prior to completing the merger of Meade Technologies with Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. which occurred on January 15, 2008 and prior to current management’s employment with our Company.  As part of the merger, the Company’s name was changed to Fund.com Inc, and its subsidiary’s name to Fund.com Capital.

The certificate of deposit accrues earned interest at 5% per annum for the term of three years and is due and payable, together with accrued interest, on November 9, 2010.  With accrued interest, the amount of the certificate of deposit was $21,888,333 as of September 30, 2009.  As disclosed in our Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 17, 2008, Global Bank had the right, pursuant to its November 2007 agreement with our Company to exchange the certificate of deposit at any time prior to its maturity for a long-term annuity contract to be issued by a third party acceptable to Global Bank.
 
 
 
51

 
 
Fund.com Capital Inc. (then known as Meade Capital, Inc.) was originally established by Meade Technologies, Inc., the Company’s predecessor, to invest in financial entities and structure unregistered financial products and instruments, including fund management companies, and structured products offered or managed by such entities. As a result, at the time of the merger with Meade Technologies in January 2008, the Company believed that the certificate of deposit investment would provide the Company with a material asset base, would serve as the basis for unregistered structure products and would provide capital for one or more potential acquisitions within its then business model as set forth in its business plan disclosed in a Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on January 17, 2008.  However, in view of the Company’s need for additional working capital, its decision to abandon the issuance of unregistered structured products in favor of pursuing exclusively investment products registered under the Securities Act and Global Bank’s right to exchange and swap the three year certificate of deposit for a long-term annuity instrument that would not provide the Company with liquidity, our management determined that it would need to seek additional financing for the Company in order to support our other strategic initiatives, and could no longer place undue reliance on the investment in the certificate of deposit. 
 
Consistent with the above strategy, pursuant to the Company’s investment in and transaction with Vensure Employer Services, Inc. (as described below), as payment for the Series A preferred stock of Vensure, the Company transferred and assigned its rights under the certificate of deposit to Vensure, effective as of September 29, 2009.  In October 2009, Global Bank advised the Company of its intention to exercise its contractual rights to exchange the certificate of deposit for a ten year 5.0% annuity contract in the amount of the certificate of deposit plus accrued interest issued by a third party. On November 2, 2009 Vensure agreed to accept such annuity contract in lieu of the certificate of deposit.

Accounting Standards Updates

In June 2009, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued its final Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 168,The FASB Accounting Standards Codification and the Hierarchy of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles a Replacement of FASB Statement No. 162”. SFAS No. 168 made the FASB Accounting Standards Codification (the Codification) the single source of U.S. GAAP used by nongovernmental entities in the preparation of financial statements, except for rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) under authority of federal securities laws, which are sources of authoritative accounting guidance for SEC registrants. The Codification is meant to simplify user access to all authoritative accounting guidance by reorganizing U.S. GAAP pronouncements into roughly 90 accounting topics within a consistent structure; its purpose is not to create new accounting and reporting guidance. The Codification supersedes all existing non-SEC accounting and reporting standards and was effective for the Company beginning July 1, 2009. Following SFAS No. 168, the Board will not issue new standards in the form of Statements, FASB Staff Positions, or Emerging Issues Task Force Abstracts; instead, it will issue Accounting Standards Updates (ASU). The FASB will not consider ASUs as authoritative in their own right; these updates will serve only to update the Codification, provide background information about the guidance, and provide the bases for conclusions on the change(s) in the Codification.

In August 2009, the FASB issued ASU 2009-05 which includes amendments to Subtopic 820-10, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures—Overall”. The update provides clarification that in circumstances, in which a quoted price in an active market for the identical liability is not available, a reporting entity is required to measure fair value using one or more of the techniques provided for in this update. The amendments in this ASU clarify that a reporting entity is not required to include a separate input or adjustment to other inputs relating to the existence of a restriction that prevents the transfer of the liability and also clarifies  that both a quoted price in an active market for the identical liability at the measurement date and the quoted price for the identical liability when traded as an asset in an active market when no adjustments to the quoted price of the asset are required are Level 1 fair value measurements. The guidance provided in this ASU is effective for the first reporting period, including interim periods, beginning after issuance.  The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations as of September 30, 2009 as the Company’s material investment was made effective September 29, 2009 just one day prior to the end of the quarter.  This standard may have a material impact in future reporting periods.
 
In September 2009, the FASB issued ASU 2009-06, Income Taxes (Topic 740), ”Implementation Guidance on Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes and Disclosure Amendments for Nonpublic Entities”, which provides implementation guidance on accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, as well as eliminates certain disclosure requirements for nonpublic entities.  For entities that are currently applying the standards for accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, this update shall be effective for interim and annual periods ending after September 15, 2009. For those entities that have deferred the application of accounting for uncertainty in income taxes in accordance with paragraph 740-10-65-1(e), this update shall be effective upon adoption of those standards. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have an impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations since this accounting standard update provides only implementation and disclosure amendments.
 
 
52

 
 
In September 2009, the FASB has published ASU No. 2009-12, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (Topic 820) - Investments in Certain Entities That Calculate Net Asset Value per Share (or Its Equivalent)”. This ASU amends Subtopic 820-10, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures – Overall”, to permit a reporting entity to measure the fair value of certain investments on the basis of the net asset value per share of the investment (or its equivalent). This ASU also requires new disclosures, by major category of investments including the attributes of investments within the scope of this amendment to the Codification. The guidance in this Update is effective for interim and annual periods ending after December 15, 2009. Early application is permitted. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In October 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-13, “Revenue Recognition (Topic 605)-Multiple Deliverable Revenue Arrangements”, which addresses the accounting for multiple-deliverable arrangements to enable vendors to account for products or services (deliverables) separately rather than as a combined unit. Specifically, this guidance amends the criteria in Subtopic 605-25, “Revenue Recognition-Multiple-Element Arrangements”, for separating consideration in multiple-deliverable arrangements. This guidance establishes a selling price hierarchy for determining the selling price of a deliverable, which is based on: (a) vendor-specific objective evidence; (b) third-party evidence; or (c) estimates. This guidance also eliminates the residual method of allocation and requires that arrangement consideration be allocated at the inception of the arrangement to all deliverables using the relative selling price method and also requires expanded disclosures. The guidance in this update is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
 
In October 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-14, “Software (Topic 985)-Certain Revenue Arrangements that Include Software Elements” and changes the accounting model for revenue arrangements that include both tangible products and software elements. Under this guidance, tangible products containing software components and non-software components that function together to deliver the tangible product's essential functionality are excluded from the software revenue guidance in Subtopic 985-605, “Software-Revenue Recognition”. In addition, hardware components of a tangible product containing software components are always excluded from the software revenue guidance.  The guidance in this ASU is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In December 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-16 “Transfers and Servicing (Topic 860): Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets.” ASU No. 2009-16 is a revision to ASC 860, “Transfers and Servicing,” and amends the guidance on accounting for transfers of financial assets, including securitization transactions, where entities have continued exposure to risks related to transferred financial assets. ASU No. 2009-16 also expands the disclosure requirements for such transactions. This ASU will become effective for us on April 1, 2010.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
 
In December 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-17 “Consolidations (Topic 810): Improvements to Financial Reporting by Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities.” ASU No. 2009-17 amends the guidance for consolidation of VIEs primarily related to the determination of the primary beneficiary of the VIE. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
 
In January 2010, the FASB has published ASU 2010-01 “Equity (Topic 505) - Accounting for Distributions to Shareholders with Components of Stock and Cash—a consensus of the FASB Emerging Issues Task Force,” as codified in ASC 505. ASU No. 2010-01 clarifies the treatment of certain distributions to shareholders that have both stock and cash components. The stock portion of such distributions is considered a share issuance that is reflected in earnings per share prospectively and is not a stock dividend. The amendments in this Update are effective for interim and annual periods ending on or after December 15, 2009 and should be applied on a retrospective basis.  Early adoption is permitted.  The adoption of this standard did/did not have an impact on the Company’s (consolidated) financial position and results of operations.
 
 
53

 
 
In January 2010, the FASB has published ASU 2010-02 “Consolidation (Topic 810) - Accounting and Reporting for Decreases in Ownership of a Subsidiary—a Scope Clarification,” as codified in ASC 810, “Consolidation.” ASU No. 2010-02 applies retrospectively to April 1, 2009, our adoption date for ASC 810-10-65-1 as previously discussed in this financial note. This ASU clarifies the applicable scope of ASC 810 for a decrease in ownership in a subsidiary or an exchange of a group of assets that is a business or nonprofit activity. The ASU also requires expanded disclosures. The amendments in this Update are effective for interim and annual periods ending on or after December 15, 2009, and should be applied on a retrospective basis.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In January 2010, the FASB has published ASU 2010-06 “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (Topic 820): - Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements”. ASU No. 2010-06 clarifies improve disclosure requirement related to fair value measurements and disclosures – Overall Subtopic (Subtopic 820-10) of the FASB Accounting Standards Codification. The new disclosures and clarifications of existing disclosures are effective for interim and annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2009, except for the disclosure about purchase, sales, issuances, and settlement in the roll forward of activity in Level 3 fair value measurements.  Those disclosures are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010, and for interim periods within those fiscal years. The amendments in this Update are effective for interim and annual periods ending on or after December 15, 2009, and should be applied on a retrospective basis.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
  
Other ASUs not effective until after December 31, 2009, are not expected to have a significant effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

We have no off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on our financial conditions, changes in financial condition, revenue or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.


Not applicable.

 
54

 
 
 




REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM


To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of
Fund.com, Inc. and Subsidiaries

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Fund.com, Inc. and Subsidiaries (a Development Stage Company) as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in stockholders' equity, and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 and the period from September 20, 2007 (inception) through December 31, 2009.  These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Fund.com, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 and the results of its consolidated operations and its consolidated cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008 and the period from September 20, 2007 (inception) through December 31, 2009 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.



/s/ Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates


Hollywood, Florida
April 22, 2010

200 South Park Road, Suite 150  •  Hollywood, Florida 33021  •  Main 954.922.5885  •  Fax 954.922.5957  •  www.jsw-cpa.com
Member - American Institute of Certified Public Accountants • Florida Institute of Certified Public Accountants
Private Companies Practice Section of the AICPA • Registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board of the SEC
 
F-1

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
           
(A Development Stage Company)
           
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
           
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and December 31, 2008
       
             
             
             
   
December 31,
2009
   
December 31,
2008
 
ASSETS
           
             
CURRENT ASSETS
           
   Cash
  $ 269,864     $ 158,083  
   Accounts receivable
    74,128          
   Prepaid expenses
    89,000          
     Total current assets
    432,992       158,083  
                 
Property, plant and equipment, net
    4,555       122  
                 
Intangible Assets, net
    8,205,000       9,999,500  
                 
Investments
    18,216,469       -  
                 
Certificate of Deposit
    -       21,138,333  
                 
Advances from future revenues
    3,771,864          
                 
Advances on behalf of noncontrolling stockholder
    510,862       106,333  
                 
TOTAL ASSETS
  $ 31,141,743     $ 31,402,371  
                 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
               
                 
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
               
   Accounts payable
  $ 1,612,927     $ 1,085,210  
   Accrued payroll
    540,474          
   Accrued expenses
    67,500          
   Advances from stockholders
    -       23,580  
   Current portion of notes payable
    -       443,000  
    Total current liabilities
    2,220,901       1,551,790  
                 
LONG TERM LIABILITIES
               
   Note payable
    127,861       -  
                 
TOTAL LIABILITIES
    2,348,763       1,551,790  
                 
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
               
Preferred stock, $.001 par value, 10,000,000 shares authorized,
         
     400,000 issued and outstanding in 2009 (none in 2008)
    400       -  
Class A Common stock, $0.001 par value, 300,000,000 shares
         
     authorized; 46,115,905 and 44,087,335 shares issued and outstanding
    46,116       44,087  
     at December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively
               
Class B Common stock, $0.001 par value, 10,000,000 shares
         
     authorized; 6,387,665 shares issued and outstanding at
    6,388       6,388  
     December 31, 2009 and 2008
               
   Additional paid-in-capital
    37,996,309       33,492,056  
   Stock subscriptions
    609,250       -  
   Accumulated deficit during the Development Stage
    (9,865,483 )     (3,691,950 )
      Total stockholders' equity
    28,792,980       29,850,581  
                 
    TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
  $ 31,141,743     $ 31,402,371  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements
 
 
F-2

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
                 
(A Development Stage Company)
                 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                 
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2009 AND 2008, AND
                 
SEPTEMBER 20, 2007 (INCEPTION) THROUGH DECEMBER 31, 2009
                 
                   
               
September 20, 2007
 
   
Year Ended
   
Year Ended
   
(Inception) through
 
   
December 31, 2009
   
December 31, 2008
   
December 31, 2009
 
                   
Revenue
  $ 279,006     $ -     $ 279,006  
 
                       
Costs of revenue
    -       -       -  
                         
  Gross profit
    279,006       -       279,006  
                         
Operating expense
    5,509,113       4,551,545       10,448,440  
                         
Loss from operations before interest income and
                       
  provision for (benefit from) income tax
    (5,230,107 )     (4,551,545 )     (10,169,434 )
                         
  Other income
    -       1,754       1,754  
  Interest income
    751,524       1,001,021       1,891,006  
  Impairment charge - intangible asset
    (1,794,500 )             (1,794,500 )
  Interest expense
    (304,979 )             (304,979 )
  Income tax expense
    -       -       (193 )
      (1,347,955 )     1,002,775       (206,911 )
                         
Noncontrolling interest
    404,529       76,520       510,862  
                         
Net loss
  $ (6,173,533 )   $ (3,472,250 )   $ (9,865,483 )
                         
Net loss per common share - basic and diluted (Class A & B)
  $ (0.06 )   $ (0.03 )   $ (0.09 )
                         
Weighted average number of shares outstanding:
                       
   during the year - basic and diluted (Class A)
    45,355,191       43,829,002       43,420,753  
                         
Weighted average number of shares outstanding:
                       
   during the year - basic and diluted (Class B)
    6,387,665       6,387,665       6,387,665  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements
 
F-3

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
(A Development Stage Company)
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
FOR THE PERIOD SEPTEMBER 20, 2007 (INCEPTION) THROUGH DECEMBER 31, 2009
 
     
Preferred Stock$.
001 par value
     
Common Stock - Class A
$.001 par value
     
Common Stock - Class B$.
001 par value
     
Additional
                   
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Shares
   
Amount
   
Paid in
Capital
   
Stock
Subscriptions
   
Accumulatd
Deficit
   
Total
 
                                                             
 September 20, 2007 (inception)
    -     $ -       -     $ -                 $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
                                                                             
 Shares issued to founders
    -       -       18,700,000       187                   1,377       -       -       1,564  
 
                                                                           
 Issuance of shares through first
                                                                           
     private placement
    2,500,000       2,500       5,000,000       50                   9,997,450       -               10,000,000  
                                                                             
 Issuance of shares through second
                                                                           
      private placement
    -       -       10,350,000       101                   20,699,899       -               20,700,000  
                                                                             
 AdvisorShares capitalization
                                                5,000       -               5,000  
                                                                             
 Net loss
    -       -       -       -                   -       -       (219,700 )     (219,700 )
                                                                             
December 31, 2007
    2,500,000     $ 2,500       34,050,000     $ 338       -     $ -     $ 30,703,726       -     $ (219,700 )   $ 30,486,864  
                                                                                 
Merger with Eastern Services Holdings
    (2,500,000 )     (2,500 )     9,562,335       43,274       6,387,665       6,388       (47,162 )     -       -       -  
                                                                                 
 Issuance of shares through third
                                                                               
     private placement
    -       -       475,000       475       -       -       949,525       -       -       950,000  
                                                                                 
Stock option grant expense
    -       -       -       -       -       -       1,880,967       -       -       1,880,967  
                                                                                 
Additional AdvisorShares capitalization
    -       -       -       -       -       -       5,000       -       -       5,000  
                                                                                 
Net loss
    -       -       -       -       -       -       -       -       (3,472,250 )     (3,472,250 )
                                                                                 
December 31, 2008
    -       -       44,087,335     $ 44,087       6,387,665     $ 6,388     $ 33,492,056       -     $ (3,691,950 )   $ 29,850,581  
                                                                                 
Issuance of restricted common shares
                    2,028,570       2,029                       402,971                       405,000  
                                                                                 
Beneficial conversion features of note payable
                                              2,466,444                       2,466,444  
                                                                                 
Conversions of Note Payable
                                                                               
   Issuance of preferred stock
    400,000       400                                       (400 )                     0  
   Stock subscriptions
                                                    (509,250 )                     (509,250 )
                                                                                 
Stock subscriptions (see note 6)
                                                            609,250               609,250  
                                                                                 
Stock option grant expense
                                                    2,144,488                       2,144,488  
                                                                                 
Net loss
                                                                    (6,173,533 )     (6,173,533 )
                                                                                 
December 31, 2009
    400,000     $ 400       46,115,905     $ 46,116       6,387,665     $ 6,388     $ 37,996,309     $ 609,250     $ (9,865,483 )   $ 28,792,980  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements
 
F-4

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
(A Development Stage Company)
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2009 AND 2008, AND
SEPTEMBER 20, 2007 (INCEPTION) THROUGH DECEMBER 31, 2009
 
               
September 20, 2007
 
   
Year Ended
   
Year Ended
   
(Inception) through
 
   
December 31, 2009
   
December 31, 2008
   
December 31, 2009
 
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
                 
                   
  Net loss
  $ (6,173,533 )   $ (3,472,250 )   $ (9,865,483 )
  Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash
                       
    used in operating activities:
                       
    Compensation recognized under stock incentive plan
    2,144,488       1,880,967       4,025,455  
    Noncontrolling interest
    (404,529 )     (76,520 )     (510,862 )
    Impairment of intangible asset
    1,794,500               1,794,500  
  Changes in assets and liabilities:
                       
     Increase in accounts receivable
    (74,128 )             (74,128 )
     Increase in prepaid expense
    (89,000 )             (89,000 )
     Increase in accounts payable
    517,258       876,108       1,602,468  
     Increase in accrued payroll
    540,474               540,474  
     Increase in accrued expenses
    67,500               67,500  
     Accrued interest from certificate of deposit
    -       (1,000,000 )     (1,138,333 )
          Net cash used in operating activities
    (1,676,971 )     (1,791,695 )     (3,647,410 )
                         
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
                       
     Purchase of Property, Plant and Equipment
    (4,433 )     -       (4,555 )
     Certificate of deposit
    21,888,333       -       1,888,333  
     Investment in entities
    (18,216,469 )             (18,216,469 )
     Advances from future revenues
    (3,771,864 )             (3,771,864 )
     Purchase of intangible asset
    -       -       (9,999,500 )
          Net cash used in  investing activities
    (104,433 )     -       (30,104,055 )
                         
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
                       
      Proceeds from the sale of stock
    2,359,765       955,000       34,021,329  
      Proceeds from Notes Payable
    -       443,000       443,000  
      Repayment of Notes Payable
    (443,000 )             (443,000 )
      Advances from stockholders
            -       77,150  
      Repayment of stockholders advances
    (23,580 )     (53,570 )     (77,150 )
          Net cash provided by financing activities
    1,893,185       1,344,430       34,021,329  
                         
INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH
    111,781       (447,265 )     269,864  
                         
CASH, BEGINNING OF YEAR
    158,083       605,348       -  
                         
CASH, END OF YEAR
  $ 269,864     $ 158,083     $ 269,864  
                         
Supplemental Disclosures
                       
                         
Cash paid during the year for interest
  $ -     $ -     $ -  
Cash paid during the year for taxes
  $ -     $ -     $ -  
                         
Supplemental disclosure of non-cash financing activities
                       
                         
   Acquisition of investment in entity with exchange
                       
      in investment in certificate of deposit
  $ 18,216,469     $ -     $ -  
                         
   Compensation recognized under stock incentive plan
  $ 2,144,488     $ 1,880,967     $ 4,025,455  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements
 
F-5

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
NOTE 1 – ORGANIZATION

Fund.com Inc. (the “Company” or “Fund’) was incorporated in the state of Delaware on September 20, 2007.  The Company is in its development stage and has not begun the process of operating its business.  The Company is still in the process of researching and developing its business and raising capital.

History of the Company

On September 27, 2007, the following wholly owned subsidiaries were incorporated:

      
Fund.com Online Technologies Inc. (“FOT”) was incorporated in the state of Delaware. FOT is a wholly owned operating subsidiary of the Company and was established to acquire the domain name “fund.com” and other related intellectual property and assets.  The subsidiary will be responsible for operating the Company’s internet properties.

•      
Fund.com Managed Products Inc. (“FMP”) was incorporated in the state of Delaware.  FMP is a wholly owned operating subsidiary of the Company that focuses on asset management advisory services and related products.

•      
Fund.com Capital Inc. (“FC”) was incorporated in the state of Delaware.  FC is a wholly owned operating subsidiary of FMP that will serve as an investment vehicle for the purposes of making active (non-passive) investments in other financial institutions, fund management companies or, in certain instances, products offered or managed by either.

On October 12, 2006, AdvisorShares Investments, LLC (“AdvisorShares”) was incorporated in the state of Delaware.  AdvisorShares is a developer of proprietary exchange traded funds, also known as ETFs, with a focus on “actively managed” ETFs.  On October 31, 2008, the Company purchased a 60% of the outstanding membership interests of AdvisorShares.

On June 1, 2009, Whyte Lyon Socratic Inc. (“WLS”) was incorporated in the state of New York.  WLS is a developer of online education programs for investors, debtors and professionals.  On November 2, 2009, the Company acquired all of the outstanding shares of WLS.

Overview of Organizations

Fund.com Inc. is a provider of fund management products and risk management solutions that help financial advisors, wealth managers, institutions, and ultra-high-net-worth families create and manage wealth. We also offer services and investment fund information to the mass-market individual investor over the Internet at www.fund.com.

The business of AdvisorShares is to develop a diverse range of "actively managed" exchange traded funds (“ETFs”) together with established third party asset managers, and to list these ETFs on the New York Stock Exchange, or a similar national or international securities exchange. The target clients of AdvisorShares are third party investment advisors who already manage clients' assets, have a favorable track record and desire to package their investment strategy using exchange-traded funds.  Under our business model, the investment manager acts as a “sub-advisor” to the fund and selects and supervises the investments of its individual ETF.  By accessing the AdvisorShares ETF platform, third party investment managers will be able to establish their own branded, or "white-labeled," ETF on a "turn-key" basis, wherein AdvisorShares is responsible, among other things, for the compliance and administration of the fund.  AdvisorShares and the investment manager share in the fee income, subject to a monthly minimum paid to AdvisorShares.

WLS is a development stage online provider of financial literacy video content delivered over the Internet. Sometimes referred to as distance learning, such remote educational content is designed to assist on-line students to:
 
        develop the necessary skills to understand financial transactions and financial markets;
     develop money management skills to help them manage their income and wealth; and
     reach particular goals, including homeownership, debt reconciliation, or improved credit reports.
 
Simultaneous with our acquisition of WLS, we purchased an equity interest in Vensure Employer Services, Inc., (“Vensure”) a professional employer organization, or PEO, located in Mesa, Arizona.  Vensure provides a broad range of services to small and medium-sized businesses, consisting of benefits and payroll administration, health and workers’ compensation insurance programs, personnel records management, employer liability management, employee recruiting and selection, employee performance management, employee training and development services and retirement obligations, including a retirement services product line that offers a variety of options to clients like 401(k) plans, profit sharing, and money purchase plans.

 
F-6

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
NOTE 1 – ORGANIZATION (continued)

On March 29, 2010, we consummated the acquisition of 100% of the membership interests of Weston Capital Management, LLC (“Weston Capital”).  Founded in 1993 and headquartered in West Palm Beach, FL, Weston Capital has three lines of business: it originates and markets fund of funds; it originates and markets single-manager hedge funds; and it raises capital to seed new hedge funds.  Weston Capital currently earns fees on assets exceeding $1.0 billion under management.  Its founder Albert Hallac continues as CEO of Weston Capital, directing its day-to-day operations and business strategy, and our Chairman Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of Weston Capital. Weston Capital also has offices in London and New York City.   Management believes with Weston Capital’s operations, when aligned with our majority interest in AdvisorShares, will enable us to accelerate increases of assets under management since we now has the ability to seed, originate and distribute hedge funds as well as seed, originate, develop and distribute actively traded ETFs to institutional and retail investors. 

NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

These financial statements and related notes are presented in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Significant accounting policies are as follows:

Basis of Presentation

The Company has not produced any significant revenue from its principal business and is a development stage company as defined by the Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 915 Development Stage Entities.

Principles of Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Fund.com Inc. and its subsidiaries.  All material intercompany accounts and transactions are eliminated in consolidation. The year end for the Company and its subsidiaries is December 31.  Certain reclassifications have been made in the 2008 results to conform to the presentation used in 2009.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements.  These estimates and assumptions also affect the reported amounts of revenues, costs and expenses during the reporting period.  Management evaluates these estimates and assumptions on a regular basis.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Revenue Recognition

The Company recognizes revenue in accordance with ASC 605 Revenue Recognition which established that revenue can be recognized when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, the product has been shipped, all significant contractual obligations have been satisfied and collection is reasonably assured.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

The Company considers all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents.  Cash and cash equivalents are defined to include cash on hand and cash in the bank.

Certificate of Deposit

On November 9, 2007, the Company deposited $20,000,000 into a fixed Certificate of Deposit with an interest rate of 5.00% per annum payable at maturity, for a term of three years.  Accrued interest of $750,000 and $1,000,000 has been recorded for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Pursuant to a securities purchase agreement dated September 24, 2009 which the Company entered into with Vensure Employer Services, Inc., the rights were assigned to receive payments under the Certificate of Deposit to Vensure, effective as of September 29, 2009 for certain consideration.  In October 2009, prior to the closing of the Vensure transaction, Global Bank of Commerce advised the Company of its intention to exercise its contractual rights to exchange the Certificate of Deposit for an annuity contract issued by a third party, and on November 2, 2009 Vensure agreed to accept such annuity contract in lieu of the certificate of deposit.

 
F-7

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

Investments

The Company’s investment portfolio consists of an investment in exchange traded funds which are held as available for sale and a long-term preferred stock investment in Vensure Employer Services Inc. (see footnote 10) which is recorded at cost and will be evaluated for other than temporary impairment on a quarterly basis in accordance with ASC 820 Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures
 
The Company’s policy for the evaluation of temporarily impaired securities to determine whether the impairment is other-than temporary is based on analysis of the following factors: (1) rating downgrade or other credit event (e.g., failure to pay interest when due); (2) financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer or non-issuer, including any specific events which may influence the operations of the issuer or non-issuer such as changes in technology or discontinuance of a business segment; (3) prospects for the issuer’s or non-issuer’s industry segment; and (4) intent and ability of the Company to retain the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for anticipated recovery in fair value. The Company evaluates its investments in securities to determine other than temporary impairment, no less than quarterly. Investments that are deemed other than temporarily impaired are written down to their estimated net fair value and the related losses are recognized in operations.

After the Company’s review of its investment portfolio in relation to the above policy, there were no permanently impaired investments noted during the years ended December 31, 2009.   

Advertising Costs

All advertising costs are charged to expense as incurred. There was no material advertising expense for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.

Research and Development

The Company does not engage in research and development as defined in ASC Topic 730, “Accounting for Research and Development Costs.”  However, the Company does incur costs including salaries and consulting fees related to its website.  These costs are included in Operating Expense in the Statement of Operations.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment is recorded at cost and depreciated over the estimated useful lives of the assets using principally the straight-line method. When items are retired or otherwise disposed of, income is charged or credited for the difference between net book value and proceeds realized thereon.  Ordinary maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred, and replacements and betterments are capitalized.  The range of estimated useful lives to be used to calculate depreciation for principal items of property and equipment are as follow:
 
Asset Category
 
Depreciation/ Amortization Period
Furniture and Fixture
 
  3 Years
Office equipment
 
  3 Years
Leasehold improvements
 
  5 Years

Income Taxes

Deferred income taxes are recognized based on the provisions of ASC Topic 740 Income Taxes for the tax consequences in future years of differences between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their financial reporting amounts based on enacted tax laws and statutory tax rates applicable to the periods in which the differences are expected to affect taxable income. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized.

In July 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued guidance codified in Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 740-10-25 “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes”. ASC Topic 740-10-25 supersedes guidance codified in ASC Topic 450, “Accounting for Contingencies”, as it relates to income tax liabilities and lowers the minimum threshold a tax position is required to meet before being recognized in the financial statements from “probable” to “more likely than not” (i.e., a likelihood of occurrence greater than fifty percent). Under ASC Topic 740-10-25, the recognition threshold is met when an entity
 
 
F-8

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

concludes that a tax position, based solely on its technical merits, is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority. Those tax positions failing to qualify for initial recognition are recognized in the first interim period in which they meet the more likely than not standard, or are resolved through negotiation or litigation with the taxing authority, or upon expiration of the statute of limitations. De-recognition of a tax position that was previously recognized occurs when an entity subsequently determines that a tax position no longer meets the more likely than not threshold of being sustained.
 
The Company is subject to ongoing tax exposures, examinations and assessments in various jurisdictions. Accordingly, the Company may incur additional tax expense based upon the outcomes of such matters. In addition, when applicable, the Company will adjust tax expense to reflect the Company’s ongoing assessments of such matters which require judgment and can materially increase or decrease its effective rate as well as impact operating results.
 
Under ASC Topic 740-10-25, only the portion of the liability that is expected to be paid within one year is classified as a current liability. As a result, liabilities expected to be resolved without the payment of cash (e.g. resolution due to the expiration of the statute of limitations) or are not expected to be paid within one year are not classified as current. The Company has recently adopted a policy of recording estimated interest and penalties as income tax expense and tax credits as a reduction in income tax expense.
 
Fund and certain of its subsidiaries (FOT, FMP and FC) did not file federal and applicable state income tax returns for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and prior. Although the Company is incurring losses since its inception, the Company is obligated to file income tax returns for compliance with IRS regulations and that of applicable state jurisdictions. Management believes that the Company will not incur significant penalty and interest for non-filing of federal and state income tax returns, as well as, federal and state income tax liabilities, as applicable, for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and prior considering its loss making history since inception. The Company is still in the process of determining the amount of net taxable operating losses eligible to be carried forward for federal and applicable state income tax purposes for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and prior. The Company is still in the process of determining whether to file a consolidated tax return or a separate tax return for a holding company and its subsidiaries. The Company has not made any provision for federal and state income tax liabilities that may result from this uncertainty as of December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Management believes that this will not have a material adverse impact on the Company’s financial position, its results of operations and its cash flows.
 
AdvisorShares and WLS are in compliance with filing of the federal and applicable state income tax returns up until December 31, 2008.
 
The number of years with open tax audits varies depending on the tax jurisdiction. The Company’s major taxing jurisdictions include the United States (including applicable states).

Earnings Per Share         

The Company computes basic and diluted earnings per share amounts in accordance with ASC Topic 260, Earnings per Share. Basic earnings per share is computed by dividing net income (loss) available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the reporting period. Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur if stock options and other commitments to issue common stock were exercised or equity awards vest resulting in the issuance of common stock that could share in the earnings of the Company. Common shareholders include both Class A and Class B as the holders of Class A common stock shall be entitled to receive, on a pari passu basis with the holders of Class B common stock, if, as and when declared from time to time by the Board of Directors out of any assets of the Company legally available therefore, such dividends as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount at which the instrument could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties other than in a forced sale or liquidation.   The carrying amounts of financial instruments, including cash, accounts payable and accrued expenses approximate fair value because of the relatively short maturity of the instruments.

Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

The long-lived assets held and used by the Company are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of assets may not be recoverable. It is reasonably possible that these assets could become
 
 
F-9

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

impaired as a result of technology or other industry changes. Determination of recoverability of assets to be held and used is by comparing the carrying amount of an asset to future net undiscounted cash flows to be generated by the assets. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of assets exceeds the fair value of the assets. Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.

The Company tests annually the carrying value of its intangible assets for impairment in accordance with ASC Topic 350 Intangibles – Goodwill and Other and also ASC Topic 360-10-35 Subsequent Measurement.  

Stock-Based Compensation

The Company accounts for stock-based compensation in accordance with ASC 718 Compensation – Stock Compensation. The ASC provides that instruments that were originally issued as employee compensation and then modified, and that modification is made to the terms of the instrument solely to reflect an equity restructuring that occurs when the holders are no longer employees, then no change in the recognition or the measurement (due to a change in classification) of those instruments will result if both of the following conditions are met: (a) there is no increase in fair value of the award (or the ratio of intrinsic value to the exercise price of the award is preserved, that is, the holder is made whole), or the antidilution provision is not added to the terms of the award in contemplation of an equity restructuring; and (b) all holders of the same class of equity instruments (for example, stock options) are treated in the same manner.

Accounting Standards Updates

In June 2009, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued its final Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 168,The FASB Accounting Standards Codification and the Hierarchy of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles a Replacement of FASB Statement No. 162”. SFAS No. 168 made the FASB Accounting Standards Codification (the Codification) the single source of U.S. GAAP used by nongovernmental entities in the preparation of financial statements, except for rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) under authority of federal securities laws, which are sources of authoritative accounting guidance for SEC registrants. The Codification is meant to simplify user access to all authoritative accounting guidance by reorganizing U.S. GAAP pronouncements into roughly 90 accounting topics within a consistent structure; its purpose is not to create new accounting and reporting guidance. The Codification supersedes all existing non-SEC accounting and reporting standards and was effective for the Company beginning July 1, 2009. Following SFAS No. 168, the Board will not issue new standards in the form of Statements, FASB Staff Positions, or Emerging Issues Task Force Abstracts; instead, it will issue Accounting Standards Updates (ASU). The FASB will not consider ASUs as authoritative in their own right; these updates will serve only to update the Codification, provide background information about the guidance, and provide the bases for conclusions on the change(s) in the Codification.

In August 2009, the FASB issued ASU 2009-05 which includes amendments to Subtopic 820-10, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures—Overall”. The update provides clarification that in circumstances, in which a quoted price in an active market for the identical liability is not available, a reporting entity is required to measure fair value using one or more of the techniques provided for in this update. The amendments in this ASU clarify that a reporting entity is not required to include a separate input or adjustment to other inputs relating to the existence of a restriction that prevents the transfer of the liability and also clarifies  that both a quoted price in an active market for the identical liability at the measurement date and the quoted price for the identical liability when traded as an asset in an active market when no adjustments to the quoted price of the asset are required are Level 1 fair value measurements. The guidance provided in this ASU is effective for the first reporting period, including interim periods, beginning after issuance. The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations as of September 30, 2009 as the Company’s material investment was made effective September 29, 2009 just one day prior to the end of the quarter.  This standard may have a material impact in future reporting periods.

In September 2009, the FASB issued ASU 2009-06, Income Taxes (Topic 740), ”Implementation Guidance on Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes and Disclosure Amendments for Nonpublic Entities”, which provides implementation guidance on accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, as well as eliminates certain disclosure requirements for nonpublic entities.  For entities that are currently applying the standards for accounting for uncertainty in income taxes, this update shall be effective for interim and annual periods ending after September 15, 2009. For those entities that have deferred the application of accounting for uncertainty in income taxes in accordance with paragraph 740-10-65-1(e), this update shall be effective upon adoption of those standards. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have an impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations since this accounting standard update provides only implementation and disclosure amendments.

 
F-10

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

In September 2009, the FASB has published ASU No. 2009-12, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (Topic 820) - Investments in Certain Entities That Calculate Net Asset Value per Share (or Its Equivalent)”. This ASU amends Subtopic 820-10, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures – Overall”, to permit a reporting entity to measure the fair value of certain investments on the basis of the net asset value per share of the investment (or its equivalent). This ASU also requires new disclosures, by major category of investments including the attributes of investments within the scope of this amendment to the Codification. The guidance in this Update is effective for interim and annual periods ending after December 15, 2009. Early application is permitted. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
 
In October 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-13, “Revenue Recognition (Topic 605)-Multiple Deliverable Revenue Arrangements”, which addresses the accounting for multiple-deliverable arrangements to enable vendors to account for products or services (deliverables) separately rather than as a combined unit. Specifically, this guidance amends the criteria in Subtopic 605-25, “Revenue Recognition-Multiple-Element Arrangements”, for separating consideration in multiple-deliverable arrangements. This guidance establishes a selling price hierarchy for determining the selling price of a deliverable, which is based on: (a) vendor-specific objective evidence; (b) third-party evidence; or (c) estimates. This guidance also eliminates the residual method of allocation and requires that arrangement consideration be allocated at the inception of the arrangement to all deliverables using the relative selling price method and also requires expanded disclosures. The guidance in this update is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In October 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-14, “Software (Topic 985)-Certain Revenue Arrangements that Include Software Elements” and changes the accounting model for revenue arrangements that include both tangible products and software elements. Under this guidance, tangible products containing software components and nonsoftware components that function together to deliver the tangible product's essential functionality are excluded from the software revenue guidance in Subtopic 985-605, “Software-Revenue Recognition”. In addition, hardware components of a tangible product containing software components are always excluded from the software revenue guidance.  The guidance in this ASU is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In December 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-16 “Transfers and Servicing (Topic 860): Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets.” ASU No. 2009-16 is a revision to ASC 860, “Transfers and Servicing,” and amends the guidance on accounting for transfers of financial assets, including securitization transactions, where entities have continued exposure to risks related to transferred financial assets. ASU No. 2009-16 also expands the disclosure requirements for such transactions. This ASU will become effective for us on April 1, 2010.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In December 2009, the FASB has published ASU 2009-17 “Consolidations (Topic 810): Improvements to Financial Reporting by Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities.” ASU No. 2009-17 amends the guidance for consolidation of VIEs primarily related to the determination of the primary beneficiary of the VIE. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

In January 2010, the FASB has published ASU 2010-01 “Equity (Topic 505) - Accounting for Distributions to Shareholders with Components of Stock and Cash—a consensus of the FASB Emerging Issues Task Force,” as codified in ASC 505. ASU No. 2010-01 clarifies the treatment of certain distributions to shareholders that have both stock and cash components. The stock portion of such distributions is considered a share issuance that is reflected in earnings per share prospectively and is not a stock dividend. The amendments in this Update are effective for interim and annual periods ending on or after December 15, 2009 and should be applied on a retrospective basis.  Early adoption is permitted.  The adoption of this standard did/did not have an impact on the Company’s (consolidated) financial position and results of operations.

In January 2010, the FASB has published ASU 2010-02 “Consolidation (Topic 810) - Accounting and Reporting for Decreases in Ownership of a Subsidiary—a Scope Clarification,” as codified in ASC 810, “Consolidation.” ASU No. 2010-02 applies retrospectively to April 1, 2009, our adoption date for ASC 810-10-65-1 as previously discussed in this financial note. This ASU clarifies the applicable scope of ASC 810 for a decrease in ownership in a subsidiary or an exchange of a group of assets that is a business or nonprofit activity. The ASU also requires expanded disclosures. The amendments in this Update are effective for interim and annual periods ending on or after December 15, 2009, and should be applied on a retrospective basis.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have any impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.

 
F-11

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 2 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

In January 2010, the FASB has published ASU 2010-06 “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (Topic 820): - Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements”. ASU No. 2010-06 clarifies improve disclosure requirement related to fair value measurements and disclosures – Overall Subtopic (Subtopic 820-10) of the FASB Accounting Standards Codification. The new disclosures and clarifications of existing disclosures are effective for interim and annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2009, except for the disclosure about purchase, sales, issuances, and settlement in the roll forward of activity in Level 3 fair value measurements.  Those disclosures are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010, and for interim periods within those fiscal years. The amendments in this Update are effective for interim and annual periods ending on or after December 15, 2009, and should be applied on a retrospective basis.  The adoption of this standard is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position and results of operations.
  
Other ASUs not effective until after December 31, 2009, are not expected to have a significant effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

NOTE 3 – INTANGIBLE ASSET

Intellectual Property Asset:

During 2007, the Company acquired the domain name “fund.com” and other intangible assets related to intellectual property and trademarks for a total cost of $9,999,950. The Company has determined that the intangible assets have an indefinite live but are subject to periodic impairment assessment as stated in ASC 350 Intangibles – Goodwill and Other.
 
As of December 31, 2009, the Company tested the intangible assets for impairment under ASC 360-10-35-21 and determined that an impairment charge of $1,794,500 was necessary.

NOTE 4 - FAIR VALUE
 
The Company records fair value of monetary and nonmonetary instruments in accordance with ASC 820 Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures  The ASC establishes a framework for measuring fair value, establishes a fair value hierarchy based on inputs used to measure fair value, and expands disclosure about fair value measurements. Adopting this statement has not had an effect on the Company’s financial condition, cash flows, or results of operations.
 
In accordance with ASC 820, the financial instruments have been categorized, based on the degree of subjectivity inherent in the valuation technique, into a fair value hierarchy of three levels, as follows:
 
  Level 1:   Inputs are unadjusted, quoted prices in active markets for identical instruments at the measurement date (e.g., U.S. Government securities and active exchange-traded equity securities).
     
  Level 2 Inputs (other than quoted prices included within Level 1) that are observable for the instrument either directly or indirectly (e.g., certain corporate and municipal bonds and certain preferred stocks). This includes: (i) quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, (ii) quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active, (iii) inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the instruments, and (iv) inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means.
     
  Level 3:   Inputs that are unobservable. Unobservable inputs reflect the reporting entity’s subjective evaluation about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the financial instrument (e.g., certain structured securities and privately held investments).
 
 
F-12

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 4 - FAIR VALUE (continued)

The composition of the investment portfolio as of December 31, 2009 was:
 
     
Investment
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
 
Cost
 
Fair
 
Fair
 
Fair
 
Fair
 
Value
 
Value
 
Value
 
Value
 
Exchange traded funds
  $ 100,000     $ -             $ 100,000     $ 100,000  
Preferred stock
    -               18,216,469         18,216,469       18,216,469  
    $ 100,000       -     $ 18,216,469       $ 18,316,469     $ 18,316,469  
 
Our portfolio valuations classified are classified as Level 3 in the above table are priced using subjective evaluation about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the financial instrument.
 
Based on the criteria described above, the Company believes that the current level classifications are appropriate based on the valuation techniques used and that our fair values accurately reflect current market assumptions in the aggregate.
 
NOTE 5 – INVESTMENTS

The Company’s investments consisted of the following as of December 31, 2009

   
Fair
   
Original
   
Realized
   
Unrealized
       
Investment
 
Value
   
Cost
   
Gain (Loss)
   
Gain (Loss)
   
Total
 
Exchange traded funds
  $ 100,000     $ 100,000     $ -     $ -     $ 100,000  
Preferred stock
    18,216,469       18,216,469       -       -       18,216,469  
    $ 18,316,469     $ 18,316,469     $ -     $ -     $ 18,316,469  

Management believes that the carrying value of the preferred stock approximates fair value at December 31, 2009.  The Company had no investments for the year ended December 31, 2008.

NOTE 6 – EQUITY

Initial Capitalization

During 2007, the issuances of Class A common stock consisted of the follows:
 
   ·    18,700,000 shares common stock to its founders totaling $1,564;
    · 5,000,000 shares common stock and 2,500,000 shares preferred series A through private placement for $2.00 per unit totaling $10,000,000; and
   ·   10,350,000 shares common stock through a second private placement for $2.00 per share totaling $20,700,000.
 
Merger

On January 15, 2008, Fund.com Inc. merged (the “Merger”) with and into Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. (“Eastern”) pursuant to an Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of January 15, 2008 (the "Agreement"). In connection with the merger Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. changed its name to Fund.com Inc. (the "Surviving Corporation").  Pursuant to the Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.00001 per share of Fund (“Fund Common Stock”) was converted into the right to receive
 
 
F-13

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 6 – EQUITY (Continued)

.1278 validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A Common Stock of the Surviving Corporation; provided, however, if a holder of Fund Common Stock also held Series A Preferred Stock, par value $.001 per share, of Fund (“Fund Preferred Stock”) then each share of Fund Common Stock held by such holder was converted into the right to receive .1278 validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class B Common Stock (and Fund Preferred Stock held by such holder was cancelled).  Also pursuant to the Agreement, each share of common stock, $0.001 par value per share, of Eastern was converted into the right to receive one validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable share of Class A Common Stock of the Surviving Corporation. Holders of such shares were entitled to receive the previously declared 9-for-1 stock dividend payable to holders of record as of January 15, 2008.

As a result, at closing (and giving effect to the stock dividend) the Company issued an aggregate of 37,112,345 shares of our Class A Common Stock and 6,387,665 shares of our Class B Common Stock to former shareholders of Fund.com Inc., representing 87% of our outstanding Class A Common Stock and 100% of our Class B Common Stock following the merger. The merger consideration was determined as a result of arm’s-length negotiations between the parties.

Each share of Class A Common stock has one (1) vote per share.  Each share of Class B Common Stock has ten (10) votes per share.  The holders of Class B Common Stock have the right to convert each share of Class B Common Stock into one share of Class A Common Stock (adjusted to reflect subsequent stock splits, combinations, stock dividends and recapitalizations). Subject to the prior rights of holders of all classes of stock at the time outstanding having prior rights as to dividends, the holders of Class A Common Stock shall be entitled to receive, on a pari passu basis with the holders of Class B Common Stock, if, as and when declared from time to time by the Board of Directors out of any assets of the Company legally available therefore, such dividends as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors.

Common Shares Issued

In connection with a private placement, the Company issued 475,000 shares of its Class A common stock at $2.00 per share for total proceeds of $950,000 during 2008.  In 2009, 2,028,570 restricted Class A common stock were issued to an officer and related party, the Fabric Group, LLC in exchange for $405,000 of accounts payable.

In addition, on December 31, 2009 $840,000 of principal amount of a note payable to IP Global Investors Ltd. and Equities Media Acquisition Corp., Inc. were exchanged for 400,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock.

Stock Subscriptions

In December 2009, the Company received $100,000 in cash in connection with the option portion of the note payable agreement with IP Global.  In addition, IP Global converted $509,000 of the note payable in December 2009 to common stock (see also note 11).  In both of those circumstances, the stock certificates had not been issued as of December 31, 2009.

Stock Option Plan

On December 27, 2007, the Company adopted the Meade Technologies Inc. 2007 Incentive Compensation Plan.  Under this plan, stock options may be granted to employees, officers, consultants or others who provide services to the Company. The Plan is administered by the Board.  However, the Board may delegate any or all administrative functions under the Plan otherwise exercisable by the Board to one or more Committees.  The aggregate number of Shares authorized for issuance as Awards under the original Plan shall not exceed five million fifty-five thousand (5,055,000) Shares.  However, on April 30, 2009, the Company received majority shareholder approval to increase the amount of shares able to be granted under the Plan to ten million (10,000,000) shares.  The number of shares, exercise price, term and vesting are all determined by the Board at the time of grant.

On December 27, 2007, 2,076,111 stock options with a purchase price of $2.30 per share were granted to officers and employees of the Company.

On March 4, 2008, 2,500,000 stock options with a purchase price of $3.50 were granted to officers, employees and a director of the Company.

On March 28, 2008, 250,000 stock options with a purchase price of $4.00 were granted to a director of the Company.

On May 16, 2008, 250,000 stock options with a purchase price of $4.00 were granted to a director of the Company.

On August 6, 2008, 653,000 stock options with a purchase price of $3.25 were granted to an officer, employee and director of the Company.

 
F-14

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 6 – EQUITY (Continued)
 
On October 26, 2009, 1,600,000 stock options with a purchase price of $.60 were granted to officers, employees and directors of  the Company.

The Black-Scholes method option pricing model was used to estimate fair value as of the date of grant using the following assumptions:
 
Risk-Free
 
1.66% - 4.23%
Expected volatility
 
50%- 83%
Forfeiture rate
 
10%
Expected life
 
4 Years
Expected dividends
 
-
 
The following details stock options for the year ending December 31, 2009:

               
Weighted
   
Weighted
 
               
Average
   
Average
 
         
Weighted
   
Remaining
   
Grant Date
 
         
Average
   
Contractual
   
Fair
 
   
Shares
   
Exercise Price
   
Term (Years)
   
Value
 
                         
Balance, December 31, 2007
    2,076,111     $ 2.30           $ 0.78  
Granted
    3,653,000     $ 3.52           $ 2.04  
Exercised
    -       -             -  
Canceled
    -       -             -  
Forfeited
    -       -             -  
Balance, December 31, 2008
    5,729,111     $ 3.08     $ 3.06     $ 1.58  
Granted
    -       -               -  
Exercised
    -       -               -  
Canceled
    -       -               -  
Forfeited
    (1,453,565 )   $ 2.30                  
Balance, Sept 30, 2009
    4,275,546     $ 3.34     $ 2.58     $ 1.86  
Exercisable, Sept  30, 2009
    1,547,028     $ 3.09     $ 2.58     $ 1.61  

The following details stock option vested shares for the years ending December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007:
 
   
Shares
 
Balance, December 31, 2007
    -  
Vested
    -  
Balance, December 31, 2008
    -  
Vested
    2,968,484  
Balance, December 31, 2009
    2,968,484  

Based on the assumptions noted above, the fair market value of the options issued was valued at $8,041,681.

For the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, there was $2,144,488 and $1,880,967, respectively, in expense recorded in the Statement of Operations for stock option grants.  There was no expense recorded for the year ended December 31, 2007.

 
F-15

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009

NOTE 7 – RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

On March 4, 2008, Fund.com Inc. (the “Company”) entered into a Consulting Agreement with Fabric Group, LLC (“Fabric”). Fabric is wholly-owned and managed by the chairman, director and former Chief Executive Officer of the Company.  Under the Consulting Agreement, Fabric will receive an annual base fee of $300,000, in return for strategic consulting services provided by both the Chairman and the Chief Marketing Officer of the Company in the areas of business development, product marketing and online strategy and for performance of other duties as requested from time to time by the Board.  In addition, pursuant to the Consulting Agreement, Fabric will receive a onetime fee of $55,000 for services previously rendered to the Company. Included in the operating expenses for the six months ending June 30, 2009 and 2008 are $150,000 and $130,000, respectively.  Included in accounts payable as of June 30, 2009 is $405,000 related to this agreement.  This agreement has been mutually terminated and Fabric has agreed to accept in lieu of payment of $405,000, a total of 1,928,570 shares equally distributed to Lucas Mann and Daniel Klaus at 964,285 each.

On March 4, 2008, the Company entered into a Consulting Agreement with MKL Consulting Ltd. (“MKL”). MKL is wholly-owned and managed by the executive vice president and a director of the Company. Under the Consulting Agreement, MKL will receive an annual base fee of $150,000, in consideration for services provided to the Company as Executive Vice President and for performance of other duties as requested from time to time by the Board.  In addition, pursuant to the Consulting Agreement, MKL will receive a one-time fee of $25,000 for services previously rendered to the Company. This agreement was not renewed and expired on February 28, 2009 under the terms of the agreement.  Included in the operating expenses for the years ending December 31, 2009 and 2008 are $25,000 and $150,000, respectively.  Included in accounts payable as of December 31, 2009, is $150,000 related to this agreement.

As a further inducement to the IP Global to make available the line of credit, Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann, two shareholders of the Company and members of the board of directors at the time, also sold to the lenders or their designees (in equal amounts) a total of 2,000,000 of their shares of Class A common stock of the Company at a price of $0.25 per share, payable on the basis of $50,000 in cash and the $450,000 balance evidenced by two notes of $225,000 each payable in equal monthly installments through December 31, 2009.  In addition, Messrs. Klaus and Mann each contributed 500,000 of their Company shares to the lenders, or their designees, for no consideration, and granted the lenders or their designees an option, exercisable at any time up to December 31, 2009, to purchase an additional 2,000,000 of their Class A shares for $0.25 per share. Effective August 28, 2009, Messrs. Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann terminated their consulting agreements with the Company and resigned as members of the board of directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. There was no disagreement or dispute between Messrs. Klaus and Mann and the Company which led to their resignation as directors. They also agreed not to sell their remaining shares in the Company for a period of at least six months.

On October 14, 2009, the Company entered into an agreement with the stockholders of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., a Delaware corporation, d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy” (“Whyte Lyon”), to acquire 100% of the capital stock of such corporation in exchange for 500,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, which the parties valued at $2.00 per share. Closing of the acquisition of the shares of Whyte Lyon occurred on November 2, 2009 following consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement; provided, that for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments were deemed to have occurred effective on September 29, 2009.  Upon completion of the Company’s acquisition of Whyte Lyon, its principal stockholder, Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Company.

Effective December 28, 2009, IP Global sold and assigned $91,476 principal amount of its original $2.5 million convertible Note from the Company to Bleecker Holdings Corp., an entity wholly-owned by Joseph J. Bianco, our Chairman of the Board.  In connection with the Debt Restructuring Agreement, Bleecker Holdings exchanged such Note for 43,560 shares of the Company’s Series A Preferred Stock.  Such shares were subsequently sold by Bleecker to an unaffiliated third party.

On April 15, 2010, in consideration for Mr. Bianco serving as Chairman of Weston Capital, the Company assigned to Bleecker Holdings the right to receive a management fee from Weston Capital in the amount of $100,000 per annum, payable monthly.

NOTE 8 – LEASES

The Company presently has no long-term commitments for leases.

 
F-16

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
NOTE 9 – INVESTMENT IN SUBSIDIARIES

AdvisorShares Investments, LLC

On October 31, 2008, the Company entered into a Purchase and Contribution Agreement, dated as of October 31, 2008 (the “Purchase and Contribution Agreement”), with AdvisorShares Investments, LLC (“AdvisorShares”), Wilson Lane Group, LLC, and Noah Hamman, the managing member and principal officer of AdvisorShares. Pursuant to the Purchase and Contribution Agreement, the Company purchased 6,000,000 units of AdvisorShares, (representing 60% of the outstanding membership interests of AdvisorShares) for a purchase price of $4,000,000, with an initial contribution of $275,000 and up to an additional $3,725,000 being contributed to AdvisorShares in accordance with the achievement of specific milestones as defined in the Purchase and Contribution Agreement, including (i) $1,000,000 within 30 days of the issuance by the SEC of its notice regarding approval of the application of AdvisorShares for exemptive relief under the Investment Company Act of 1940; (ii) $725,000 within 30 days of receipt by the Company from AdvisorShares’ independent auditors verifying total assets under management equal to $150,000,000; (iii) $1,000,000 within 30 days of receipt by the Company from AdvisorShares’ independent auditors verifying total assets under management equal to $250,000,000; and (iv) $1,000,000 within 30 days of receipt by the Company from AdvisorShares’ independent auditors verifying total assets under management equal to $450,000,000.  In connection with our acquisition of 60% of the equity interests in AdvisorShares, we entered into an Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of AdvisorShares, dated as of October 31, 2008 (the “LLC Agreement”), and was admitted as a member of AdvisorShares. 

AdvisorShares and AdvisorShares Trust, a Delaware open-end investment management company (the “Trust”) that was recently formed by AdvisorShares for the purpose of offering a series of exchange traded funds (the “Funds”), filed an application with the SEC under the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the “Investment Company Act”) on January 31, 2008, as amended on October 17, 2008. The application requests an order from the SEC, exempting AdvisorShares and the Trust from the provisions of the Investment Company Act and permitting (a) the issuance of series of open-ended management investment companies to issue shares redeemable in large aggregations only, (b) engaging in secondary market transactions in Shares at negotiated market prices; and (c) certain affiliated persons of the series to deposit securities into, and receive securities from, the series in connection with the purchase and redemption of the creation units (the “Exemption Order”).

 On December 23, 2008, the SEC issued a notice advising that it would issue a final order granting the requested relief unless it orders a hearing on the application based on requests for a hearing given by third parties by not later than January 15, 2009.  A third party timely filed a hearing request involving an intellectual property dispute which AdvisorShares believes is unrelated to the merits of the application.  On July 20, 2009, the SEC agreed with AdvisorShares’ position and issued the final Exemptive Order approving the application.  AdvisorShares received a copy of the final Exemptive Order on July 21, 2009.

On August 18, 2009, the Company consummated payment in full of the $1,000,000 due to AdvisorShares for achieving the first milestone under the Agreement.  The funding was provided to the Company by IP Global and Equities Media, a principal stockholder of the Company, under the amended and restated $2.5 million line of credit facility described herein. The Company currently owns 60% of the outstanding units of AdvisorShares after the initial contributions of $1,275,000 by the Company. The Company will maintain its ownership of 60% of the outstanding units of AdvisorShares irrespective of AdvisorShares achieving any additional milestones. 

Whyte Lyon Socratic Inc.

On October 14, 2009, the Company entered into an agreement with the stockholders of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., a Delaware corporation, d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy” (“Whyte Lyon”) to acquire 100% of the capital stock of such corporation in exchange for 500,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, which the parties valued at $2.00 per share.  Closing of the acquisition of the shares of Whyte Lyon occurred on November 2, 2009 following consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement.  However, for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments in connection with the Whyte Lyon acquisition and the Vensure investment were deemed to have occurred effective on September 29, 2009.  Upon completion of the Company’s acquisition of Whyte Lyon, its principal stockholder, Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Company.

NOTE 10 – INVESTMENT IN VENSURE EMPLOYER SERVICES, INC.

On September 24, 2009, we and Vensure Employer Services, Inc. (“Vensure”) entered into a securities purchase agreement (the “Vensure Purchase Agreement”). Consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement occurred on November 2, 2009; provided, that for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments were deemed to have occurred effective at 5:00 p.m. on September 29, 2009.
 
Under the terms of the Vensure Purchase Agreement, we agreed to sell and assign to Vensure, our right to receive payments under the original $20.0 million certificate of deposit issued in November 2007 by Global Bank in exchange for consideration consisting of (a) 218,883.33 shares of Series A participating convertible preferred stock of Vensure (the “Series A Preferred Stock”), and (b) a seven year content agreement (the “Content Agreement”) among Vensure, Vensure Retirement Administration, Inc., a whole
 
 
F-17

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 10 – INVESTMENT IN VENSURE EMPLOYER SERVICES, INC. (continued)

owned subsidiary of Vensure, our company and Whyte Lyon. In October 2009, we were orally advised by Global Bank of its intention to elect to exercise its contractual rights to exchange and swap its obligations under the certificate of deposit for a ten year 5.0% annuity contract issued by a third party.  We notified Vensure of the banks election (which was subsequently confirmed in writing), and on November 2, 2009 Vensure agreed to accept such annuity contract in lieu of the certificate of deposit.

The Vensure Series A Preferred Stock:

·      
has a liquidation value of $100 per share or $21,888,333 as to all 218,883.33 shares;
·      
is senior to all other capital stock of Vensure;
·      
pays dividends as and when declared by the board of directors of Vensure on its common stock;
·      
on a “sale of control” (as defined) of Vensure to any unaffiliated third party, in addition to receipt of the first $21,888,333 of consideration payable in respect of Vensure capital stock, participates with the holders of the common stock to the extent of 25% of all additional consideration paid or payable in excess of the maximum $21,888,333 liquidation value of the Series A Preferred; and
·      
is convertible at any time after September 30, 2012 upon 61 days prior notice to Vensure into either 25% of the common stock of Vensure; provided, that the board of directors of Vensure may (subject to the Series A Preferred stockholder’s right to rescind its conversion notice) require that the shares of Series A Preferred Stock convert into a maximum of 49.5% of the capital stock of Vensure Retirement Administration, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Vensure.
 
Under the terms of a related stockholders agreement among the Company, Vensure and the Vensure stockholders, the Company is entitled to designate two members of the board of directors of Vensure. The stockholders agreement also contains customary buy/sell and related provisions in the event of sales of any shares of Vensure.  The Series A Preferred Stock also contains certain protective provisions that requires the approval of the Company or its designees on the board of directors of Vensure before Vensure may implement or commit to certain actions, including:
      
·      
the issuance of securities senior to or on a par with the Series A Preferred Stock;
·      
the issuance of any additional capital stock of Vensure;
·      
any change it’s the fundamental nature of its business;
·      
the acquisition of the assets or securities of other parties; or
·      
the sale or pledge of substantial assets; or
·      
any material changes in compensation of senior executive officers.
 
In addition to its receipt of the Series A Preferred Stock, the Company has received the benefits of the Content Agreement.  Under the terms of the Content Agreement, the Company and Whyte Lyon will provide all existing and future employees, co-employees and other associates (collectively, the “End Users”) of Vensure, its subsidiaries and affiliates, as well as Vensure clients (collectively, the “Vensure Group”) with access to on-line educational content to be streamed to such End-Users from the website(s) of the Vensure Group.  Such Content, to be designated and branded as “Vensure University,” “The Money School” or other brand name acceptable to the parties to the Content Agreement, will include up to 84 five to seven minute educational course segments on personal finance management, financial products and other related financial topics as are approved by Vensure and the Company.  Course segments may also include safety training, health care and other topics of interest to workers and the work place.
 
In consideration for providing the Content, the Vensure Group is required to pay the Company and its Whyte Lyon subsidiary an access fee of $19.95 per month (the “Monthly Access Fee”) for each End-User who has access to the Content from the website(s) of the Vensure Group, whether or not such End-User actually clicks on such website and views the Content.  Based on the current Vensure employment complement of approximately 4,000 employees or co-employees, this represents approximately $80,000 a month in anticipated revenues to the Company from such Monthly Access Fee as soon as the initial Content is provided.  The Company and its subsidiary have agreed to deliver approximately three course segments during each calendar quarter commencing with the quarter ending March 31, 2010 and ending December 31, 2016. Following October 2012, the $19.95 Monthly Access Fee is subject to renegotiation at the option of Vensure.
 
Our board of directors considered a number of factors in exercising its business judgment to consummate the investment in Vensure, including, among other things, the likelihood that the Global Bank certificate of deposit would not be paid on its November 2010 maturity date as was disclosed as a potential risk in the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 17, 2008. In addition, the Company considered the potential lack of liquidity arising from the proposed exchange for a long-term investment instrument.

 
F-18

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 11 – NOTES PAYABLE

Working Capital Loan with IP Global Investors LTD

For the past twelve months we have relied on loans and advances from IP Global Investors Ltd., a privately owned intellectual property finance company, to provide us with working capital to pay our operating expenses.  
 
Effective as of August 28, 2009, the Company, and IP Global consummated transactions under a line of credit agreement pursuant to which IP Global provided the Company with a $2,500,000 line of credit facility which superseded and restated in its entirety a prior $1.343 million credit agreement with IP Global entered into as of May 1, 2009.  Under the terms of the restated line of credit agreement (which was negotiated and agreed upon in early July 2009), the Company was entitled to receive a maximum of $2,500,000 of advances, less an aggregate of $723,000 of advances made through May 1, 2009 (including the $1,275,000 paid to AdvisorShares on behalf of the Company through August 18, 2009 and an additional $150,000 of advances funded through August 28, 2009).  As of December 31, 2009, the Company has borrowed an aggregate of approximately $2,466,444 under the line of credit, including $1,275,000 paid to AdvisorShares on behalf of the Company.  All obligations under the line of credit agreement have been guaranteed by Fund.com Capital Inc., Fund.com Technologies Inc. and Fund.com Managed Products Inc., all wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company.
 
The advances made under the line of credit agreement are evidenced by the Company’s 9% convertible note due August 28, 2010 (one year from the Closing Date).   The note is convertible at any time prior to its maturity date, at a conversion price of $0.21 per share into shares of Class B common stock of the Company. The conversion price was established based on the public price of Fund.com at the time the parties reached agreement, the price being based on a quantitative formula equal to 90% of the volume
weighted average price (VWAP) of the Fund.com stock price as quoted on the OTC Bulletin Board for the thirty days prior to July 6, 2009.
  
As a further inducement to the lender to make available the line of credit, Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann, two shareholders of the Company and members of the board of directors at the time, also sold to the lenders or their designees (in equal amounts) a total of 2,000,000 of their shares of Class A common stock of the Company at a price of $0.25 per share, payable on the basis of $50,000 in cash and the $450,000 balance evidenced by two notes of $225,000 each payable in equal monthly installments through December 31, 2009.  In addition, Messrs. Klaus and Mann each contributed 500,000 of their Company shares to the lender, or its designees, for no consideration, and granted the lender or its designees an option, exercisable at any time up to December 31, 2009, to purchase an additional 2,000,000 of their Class A shares for $0.25 per share. Effective August 28, 2009, Messrs. Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann terminated their consulting agreements with the Company and resigned as members of the board of directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. There was no disagreement or dispute between Messrs. Klaus and Mann and the Company which led to their resignation as directors. They also agreed not to sell their remaining shares in the Company for a period of at least six months.

On January 18, 2010, the board of directors of the Company approved the terms of an agreement (the “Debt Restructuring Agreement”) with IP Global and other third party assignees of a portion of a portion of the Note, dated as of December 28, 2009.  Under the terms of the Debt Restructuring Agreement, (a) the lender agreed to waive all prior defaults under the Note and Loan Agreement, (b) the lender and certain third party assignees who purchased from IP Global $184,800 principal amount of the Note agreed to convert an aggregate of $840,000 or 33.6% of the Note into 400,000 shares of the Company’s newly authorized Series A preferred stock; (c) the lender sold an additional $509,250 principal amount of the Note to third parties who have agreed to convert such assigned notes into shares of the Company’s Class A Common Stock, (d) the lender agreed (i) to extend the final maturity date of the remaining $1,150,750 outstanding balance of the Note to December 31, 2011, and (ii) not convert more than 25% of such Note balance into Class A Common Stock prior to December 31, 2011.

The Company’s Series A Preferred Stock does not pay a dividend, has a stated value of $100 per share, and is convertible, upon not less than 90 days prior written notice to the Company, into Class A Common Stock of the Company at a conversion price of $1.50 per share.  At the December 28, 2009 effective date of the Debt Restructuring Agreement, the average closing market prices of the Company’s Class A Common Stock, as traded on the FINRA over-the-counter Bulletin Board was approximately $0.91 per share.

As part of the transactions contemplated by the line of credit agreement, the lender or its designees received an option (expiring December 31, 2009) to purchase up to $5,000,000 of additional shares of Class A common stock of the Company at a price of $0.21 per share, or approximately 23.8 million shares of Class A common stock if such purchase option is fully exercised. The price was also established on the same VWAP calculation. The Company is not obligated to register the option shares for resale

 
F-19

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 11 – NOTES PAYABLE (continued)

with the SEC. In addition, the Company issued to IP Global a warrant, expiring July 31, 2012, entitling the holder(s) to purchase an aggregate of 50% of the number of shares of Class A common stock that are purchased upon full or partial exercise of the above purchase option, at an exercise price of $0.315 per share.  The exercise prices of the purchase option and the warrant are both subject to certain adjustments, including weighted average anti-dilution adjustments.

IP Global subsequently assigned the option to Recovery Capital, Inc. or its designees (“Recovery Capital”), and Recovery Capital thereafter assigned all or a portion of the option to Huntley Family Investments, LLC or is designees (the “Huntley Group”). The Huntley Group is affiliated with Mars Hill Partners, LLC, the sub-advisor to the Mars Hill Global Relative Value Advisorshare ETF, an actively managed exchange traded fund sponsored by AdvisorShares.  Neither Recovery Capital nor the Huntley Group is affiliated with either the Company or IP Global.

On January 25, 2010, the Company agreed to extend the option period to February 15, 2010, and the Huntley Group exercised the option and agreed to purchase all or a portion of the option shares.  To the extent not fully exercised by the Huntley Group, Recovery Capital retained the right to exercise the remaining portion of the option.  All proceeds received by the Company from the Huntley Group were to be used exclusively to provide financing to enable the Company to consummate its proposed equity investment in Weston Capital Management LLC.

On February 10, 2010, COS Capital Partners I, LLC purchased 9,047,619 Class A common stock of the Company for $1,900,000.  On March 1, 2010, LH Capital Partners LLC purchased 952,381 shares of Class A Common Stock for $200,000.  In March 2010, Recovery Capital purchased 1,080,952 shares of Class A Common Stock for $227,000.  Neither COS Capital Partners, LH Capital Partners nor Recovery Capital is affiliated with either the Company or IP Global.

On February 12, 2010, the Company agreed to further extend the Option Period to February 28, 2010.  In addition, on February 22, 2010, the Company agreed to extend the option period to March 26, 2010 and on March 26 2010, the Company agreed to extend the option to April 30, 2010.

On March 8, 2010, IP Global converted a portion of the principal amount of the then outstanding amount due under a Company Note payable to IP Global into 3,600,000 shares of Class A Common Stock which it sold to an unaffiliated third party for $1,300,000.  Pursuant to its August 29, 2010 line of credit loan agreement with the Company, IP Global advanced an additional $1,300,000 to the Company on March 29, 2010 to assist the Company in financing its acquisition of Weston Capital.  Such additional advance increased the then outstanding amount due to IP Global under the Company’s line of credit loan agreement from $730,750 to $2,030,750.  Such loan is due and payable on December 31, 2011. However, to date, the Company has been unable to pay accrued interest and fees to the lenders under the Loan Agreement.

As at March 31, 2010, an aggregate of $2,108,122 of indebtedness is outstanding under the line of credit loan agreement, including $2,030,750 in principal amount of the convertible note and an aggregate of $77,372 in unpaid accrued interest and fees.

In accordance with the guidance in ASC 845, the Company valued the transaction at the fair value of the asset relinquished, in this case the certificate of deposit.  That value was deemed to be $21,138,333 and the Company allocated that value to the preferred shares.  Upon further review, the Company now believes that it is more appropriate to also recognize the content agreement as a component of the exchange, since the Company received both assets in the exchange. Accordingly, the Company will modify its presentation and allocate the $21,138,333 to both assets acquired based on their relative fair values.  Fair value for the preferred shares was based on a fairness opinion from an independent investment banking firm.  Fair value of the content agreement was based on the net present value of the future cash flows relating to the content agreement.  Based on that evaluation, the Company has recorded its investment in preferred stock of Vensure at $18,111,469 and the content agreement at $3,771,864.  The content agreement will be reported in balance sheet as a long-lived asset titled, Advances from Future Revenues.

NOTE 12 – INCOME TAXES
 
The Company has not made provision for income taxes in the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, since the Company has the benefit of net operating losses carried forward in these periods. 
 
Due to uncertainties surrounding the Company’s ability to generate future taxable income to realize deferred income tax assets arising as a result of net operating losses carried forward, the Company has not recorded any deferred income tax asset as of December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively (see note 1). The net operating losses carryforwards will begin to expire in varying amounts from year 2027 to 2029 subject to its eligibility as determined by respective tax regulating authorities.
 
 
F-20

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 12 – INCOME TAXES (continued)
 
The Company is subject to taxation in the United States and certain state jurisdictions. The Company’s tax years for 2007 and forward are subject to examination by the United States and applicable state tax authorities due to the carry forward of unutilized net operating losses.
 
NOTE 13 – SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

On March 29, 2010, the Company consummated the acquisition (the “Acquisition”) of Weston Capital Management, LLC (“Weston Capital”), pursuant to a Securities Purchase and Restructuring Agreement dated as of March 26, 2010 (the “Purchase Agreement”) by and among the Company, Weston Capital, PBC-Weston Capital Holdings, LLC (“PBC”), Albert Hallac (“A. Hallac”) and the other persons who are parties signatory thereto (together with PBC and A. Hallac, the “Members”).

Pursuant to a newly executed long-term Employment Agreement, Weston Capital founder Albert Hallac continues as CEO of Weston Capital and a member of its board of managers and will direct Weston Capital’s day-to-day operations and business strategy.  In addition, Fund.com Chairman Joseph J. Bianco joined as Chairman of the Board of Weston Capital.

Under the Purchase Agreement:
 
    ·    the Company acquired from all of the Members, an aggregate of 100% of the membership interests in Weston Capital (the “Membership Interests”) for total consideration of $9,600,000 plus $1,500,000 in warrants described below, including:
   
  (i) 25% of the issued and outstanding Membership Interests purchased by PBC on or about June 5, 2006 (the “PBC Member Interests”), in consideration for the payment of $2,500,000 in cash and delivery of the “Warrant” described below; and
     
  (ii) he remaining 75% of the issued and outstanding Membership Interests (the “Hallac Interests”) owned by Albert. Hallac, certain members of his family, and Victor Elmaleh (collectively, the “Hallac Members”), in consideration for the payment of $5,500,000, consisting of $500,000 in cash and delivery of the Company’s 4% $5,000,000 senior secured adjustable principal amount note due March 31, 2015 (the “Reset Note”);
     
    ·    in addition to its purchase of 100% of the Membership Interests, the Company made an additional cash capital contribution to Weston Capital in the aggregate amount of $800,000 in order to fund the integration of Weston Capital and the AdvisorShares ETF business and for general working capital. The contribution was made in exchange for 9.1% of all issued and outstanding Membership Interests in Weston Capital (the “Additional Purchased Membership Interests”); and
   
    · the Company acquired the right and option, following the satisfaction of applicable regulatory approvals, to purchase 100% of the membership interests of Weston Capital’s broker-dealer subsidiary, Weston Capital Financial Services, LLC (the “Broker Subsidiary”) for nominal additional consideration.  In exchange for all of the Membership Interests in Weston Capital, the Company provided the following consideration to the Members:
   
    · cash payments equal to (i) $2,500,000 to PBC in exchange for the PBC Member Interests; (ii) $800,000 as a capital contribution to Weston Capital; and (iii) $500,000 to Albert Hallac;
   
    · a Class A common stock purchase warrant (the “Warrant”) to PBC entitling PBC to purchase, beginning September 29, 2010 (the “Six Month Anniversary Date”) through September 30, 2014, such number of shares of Class A common stock of the Company as shall be determined by dividing (A) $1,500,000, by (B) the volume weighted average price of the common stock for the 20 trading days immediately prior to the Six Month Anniversary Date; and
   
    · the Reset Note to Albert Hallac and the other Hallac Members.
 
The Company is required to make an installment payment to the holders of the Reset Note in the amount of $2,450,000 on or before May 31, 2010 (the “Installment Payment”).

The remaining principal amount of the Reset Note is subject to adjustment on each of March 31, 2013, 2014 and 2015 (each, a “Reset Date”) in such greater or lesser amount equal to the holders’ aggregate percentage interests in the then fair market value of
 
 
F-21

 
 
FUND.COM INC.
 (A Development Stage Company)
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
For the years ended December 31, 2009 and for the period September 20, 2007 (inception)
through December 31, 2009
 
NOTE 13 – SUBSEQUENT EVENTS (continued)

Weston Capital. Such fair market value is to be determined based upon an independent business appraisal.  In addition, commencing on the first Reset Date and at any time on each subsequent Reset Date, the majority of the holders aggregate percentage interest in the Reset Note shall have the right to require that all or a portion of the then outstanding principal amount of the Reset Note (as adjusted based upon such fair market value appraisal) be prepaid by the Company (a “Mandatory Prepayment”), in an amount equal to the product of multiplying (i) the then applicable holders aggregate percentage interest being prepaid and converted, by (ii) the fair market value of 100% of the membership interests in Weston Capital as at the applicable Reset Date (the “Prepayment and Conversion Amount”).  Such Prepayment and Conversion Amount shall be paid by the Company no later than 20 business days following the date of calculation of the applicable Prepayment and Conversion Amount as follows (A) 25% in cash; and (B) 75% (the “Prepayment Balance”) in such number of shares of Class A common stock as shall be equal to the quotient resulting from dividing the Prepayment Balance, by 90% of the volume weighted average price of the Class A common stock for the 20 trading days prior to the applicable Reset Date.  In the event that Albert Hallac is no longer employed by Weston Capital due to his death, resignation or termination for cause, the Company shall have the right, at the Company’s Option exercised within 90 days thereafter, to prepay and convert all of the Reset Note as set forth above (an “Optional Prepayment”).

The Company’s obligation to pay the Installment Payment, when due, and comply with its other obligations under the Reset Note is secured by a pledge by the Company of 50.9% of the Membership Interests in Weston Capital owned by the Hallac Members immediately prior to the closing date pursuant to a certain pledge agreement (the “Pledge Agreement”).

Under the terms of the Reset Note, for so long as the Company’s obligations under the Reset Note remain outstanding, the approval or consent of the holders of a majority in interest of the Reset Note or Albert Hallac is required to effect certain major transactions, including:
 
    ●    changes to Weston Capital’s Operating Agreement;
    ● any change in the fundamental nature of the business of Weston Capital;
    ● any material deviation from any permitted fund investments of Weston Capital;
    ● the dissolution, merger or consolidation of Weston Capital or a sale of control of Weston Capital;
    ● the issuance of any new Members Interests or the admission of new members in Weston Capital;
    ● the making of any cash distributions from Weston Capital to the Company unless 50.9% of each such distribution is paid in cash to the Hallac Members;
    ● the termination of the management and employment agreements with Jeffrey Hallac, Keith Wellner and Marcel Herbst for any reason other than their death, permanent disability or for Cause, as defined therein; and
    ● entering into any related party transaction with the Company or any of its affiliates.
 
The Company financed its cash payments for the Weston Capital acquisition through a series of private placements of its shares and from an advance under its August 2009 loan agreement with IP Global Investors Ltd.

On February 10, 2010, COS Capital Partners I, LLC purchased 9,047,619 Class A common stock of the Company for $1,900,000.  On March 1, 2010, LH Capital Partners LLC purchased 952,381 shares of Class A Common Stock for $200,000.  In March 2010, Recovery Capital purchased 1,080,952 shares of Class A Common Stock for $227,000.  Neither COS Capital Partners, LH Capital Partners nor Recovery Capital are affiliated with the Company or IP Global.

On March 8, 2010, IP Global converted a portion of the principal amount of the then outstanding amount due under a Company Note payable to IP Global into 3,600,000 shares of Class A Common Stock which it sold to an unaffiliated third party for $1,300,000.  Pursuant to its existing August 28, 2009 loan agreement with the Company, effective as of March 29, 2010, IP Global advanced an additional $1,300,000 to the Company to assist the Company in financing its acquisition of Weston Capital.  Such additional advance increased the outstanding amount due to IP Global under the Company’s August 2009 loan Agreement from $730,750 to $2,030,750.  Such loan is due and payable on December 31, 2011.

On April 15, 2010, in consideration for Mr. Bianco serving as Chairman of Weston Capital, the Company assigned to Bleecker Holdings the right to receive a management fee from Weston Capital in the amount of $100,000 per annum, payable monthly.
 
 
F-22

 
 
 
On March 4, 2008, on the recommendation of the Audit Committee, the Board of Directors of the Company dismissed Gately & Associates, LLC as the Company’s independent registered public accountants for any reporting period subsequent to December 31, 2007.  Gately & Associates, LLC reports on the financial statements for the preceding two years did not contain an adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion, nor were they modified as to uncertainty, audit scope, or accounting principles.  There were no disagreements with Gately & Associates, LLC on matters of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure, or auditing scope and procedure, which disagreements or reportable events would require specific disclosure as required by Item 304 of Regulation S-K.
 
We provided Gately & Associates with a copy of the disclosures in our Current Report and requested that they furnish us with a letter addressed to the Securities and Exchange Commission stating whether or not Gately & Associates agrees with the statements in Item 8 in our Current Report. Gately & Associates informed us that no such letter is necessary.

On March 4, 2008, on the recommendation of the Audit Committee, the Board of Directors approved the engagement of Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates to be the Company’s independent registered public accountants going forward.  We did not consult Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates regarding the filing of Form 10-K for the period ending December 31, 2007, nor regarding the application of accounting principles to a specific transaction, either completed or proposed, or the type of audit opinion that might be rendered on our financial statements, and no written or oral advice was provided by Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates that was a factor considered by us in reaching a decision as to the accounting, auditing or financial reporting issues.


Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

As of the end of the period covered by this annual report on Form 10-K, we evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of (i) our disclosure controls and procedures, and (ii) our internal control over financial reporting. The evaluators who performed this evaluation were our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer; their conclusions, based on and as of the date of the evaluation (i) with respect to the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and (ii) with respect to any change in our internal controls that occurred during the most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect our internal controls are presented below.
 
CEO and CFO Certifications
 
Attached to this annual report, as Exhibits 31.1 and 31.2, are certain certifications of the CEO and CFO, which are required in accordance with the Exchange Act and the Commission’s rules implementing such section (the "Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications"). This section of the annual report contains the information concerning the evaluation referred to in the Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications. This information should be read in conjunction with the Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications for a more complete understanding of the topic presented.

Disclosure Controls and Internal Controls
 
Disclosure controls are procedures designed with the objective of ensuring that information required to be disclosed in the Company's reports filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Exchange Act, such as this annual report, is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time period specified in the Commission’s rules and forms. Disclosure controls are also designed with the objective of ensuring that material information relating to the Company is made known to the CEO and the CFO by others, particularly during the period in which the applicable report is being prepared. Internal controls, on the other hand, are procedures which are designed with the objective of providing reasonable assurance that (i) the Company's transactions are properly authorized, (ii) the Company’s assets are safeguarded against unauthorized or improper use, and (iii) the Company's transactions are properly recorded and reported, all to permit the preparation of complete and accurate financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.
 
 
55

 
 
Limitations on the Effectiveness of Controls
 
The Company's management does not expect that their disclosure controls or their internal controls will prevent all error and all fraud. A control system, no matter how well developed and operated, can provide only reasonable, but not absolute assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Further, the design of the control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the Company have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by management override of the control. The design of a system of controls also is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated objectives under all potential future conditions. Over time, control may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or because the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected.
 
Scope of the Evaluation
 
The CEO and CFO’s evaluation of our disclosure controls included a review of the controls’ (i) objectives, (ii) design, (iii) implementation, and (iv) the effect of the controls on the information generated for use in this annual report. In the course of the evaluation, the CEO and CFO sought to identify data errors, control problems and acts of fraud, and they sought to confirm that appropriate corrective action, including process improvements, was being undertaken. This type of evaluation is done on a quarterly basis so that the conclusions concerning the effectiveness of our controls can be reported in our quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and annual reports on Form 10-K. The overall goals of these various evaluation activities are to monitor our disclosure controls and internal controls, and to make modifications if and as necessary. Our external auditors also review internal controls in connection with their audit and review activities. Our intent in this regard is that the disclosure controls and the internal controls will be maintained as dynamic systems that change (including improvements and corrections) as conditions warrant.
 
Among other matters, the evaluation was to determine whether there were any significant deficiencies or material weaknesses in our internal controls, which are reasonably likely to adversely affect our ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information, or whether the evaluators identified any acts of fraud, whether or not material, involving management or other employees who have a significant role in our internal controls. This information was important for both the evaluation, generally, and because the Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certifications, Item 5, require that the CEO and CFO disclose that information to our Board (audit committee), and our independent auditors, and to report on related matters in this section of the annual report. In the professional auditing literature, "significant deficiencies" are referred to as "reportable conditions". These are control issues that could have significant adverse affect on the ability to record, process, summarize and report financial data in the financial statements. A "material weakness" is defined in the auditing literature as a particularly serious reportable condition where the internal control does not reduce, to a relatively low level, the risk that misstatement caused by error or fraud may occur in amounts that would be material in relation to the financial statements and not be detected within a timely period by employees in the normal course of performing their assigned functions. The evaluators also sought to deal with other controls matters in the evaluation, and in each case, if a problem was identified, they considered what revisions, improvements and/or corrections to make in accordance with our ongoing procedures.
 
Conclusions
 
Based upon the evaluation, our CEO and CFO concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures as of December 31, 2009 were not effective such that the information required to be disclosed by us in reports filed under the Exchange Act is (i) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and (ii) accumulated and communicated to our management, including our CEO and CFO, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding disclosure. They concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls were ineffective due to the inability to timely file this report and the 2008 annual report on Form 10-K and the occurrence of issues that necessitated a restatement of interim period filings in 2009 and the material weaknesses in its internal controls over financial reporting as described below, which led us to file this report and our 2008 10-K late.  The actions being taken to address these ineffective disclosure controls and procedures are set forth below. Based upon the Evaluation, our CEO and CFO also concluded that our internal controls are not effective at that assurance level to provide reasonable assurance that our financial statements are fairly presented in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, as more fully described below.
 
 
56

 
 
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Board of Directors of Fund.com Inc:
 
Management of Fund.com Inc is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U. S. generally accepted accounting principles. The Company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the Company’s assets, (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and, (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention of timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Internal control over financial reporting includes the controls themselves, monitoring and internal auditing practices and actions taken to correct deficiencies as identified.
 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting, no matter how well designed, may not prevent or detect misstatements. Accordingly, even effective internal control over financial reporting can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. Also, the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting was made as of a specific date. Projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
  
Management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2009, based on criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting described in “Internal Control—Integrated Framework” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Management’s assessment included an evaluation of the design of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting and testing of the operational effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting. Management reviewed the results of its assessment with the Audit Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors.
 
Management determined that, as of December 31, 2009, the Company did not maintain effective internal control over financial reporting.  Management identified the following specific material weaknesses in the Company’s internal controls over its financial reporting processes (a material weakness is a deficiency, or a combination of control deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of the Company’s annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis):
 
•  
Policies and Procedures for the Financial Close and Reporting Process — Currently there are no written policies or procedures that clearly define the roles in the financial close and reporting process.  The various roles and responsibilities related to this process should be defined, documented, updated and communicated.  Failure to have such policies and procedures in place amounts to a material weakness to the Company’s internal controls over its financial reporting processes.
 
•  
Inability to close our books and generate required disclosure – Due to timing constraints related to the finalization of material agreements, we recognize a material weakness regarding our inability to simultaneously close the books on a timely basis each month and quarter and to generate all the necessary disclosure for inclusion in our filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission. This material weakness caused us to be late in our 2008 Form 10-K.

•  
Accounting and Finance Personnel Weaknesses – Our current accounting staff is relatively small and we do not have the required infrastructure of meeting the higher demands of being a U.S. public company. Due to the size of our accounting staff, we have limitations in the segregation of duties throughout the financial reporting processes.  Due to the pervasive nature of this issue, the lack of segregation of duties amounts to a material weakness to the Company’s internal controls over its financial reporting processes.
   
• 
Restatement of Interim Reporting – The occurrence of certain issues necessitated a restatement of our interim reporting.  These items included EPS calculations, disclosure of cumulative information required for development stage companies, recording the investment in Vensure and recording the funding received from IP Global.
 
 
57

 
 
In light of the foregoing, once we have the adequate funds, management plans to develop the following additional procedures to help address these material weaknesses.  We believe that these additional steps will further enhance and strengthen the remediation steps we implemented in fiscal 2008 and 2009 to address the material weaknesses we discovered in our 2007 evaluation, which we believed were sufficient to cure such material weakness.  We recognize now that these must be expanded and developed to help ensure we achieve and maintain effective controls and procedures.  The Company will create and refine a structure in which critical accounting policies and estimates are identified, and together with other complex areas, are subject to review by other members of management as well as the Company’s independent accountant.  We also plan to enhance and test our quarter-end and year-end financial close process.  Additionally, our board of directors will increase its review of our disclosure controls and procedures.  We also intend to develop and implement policies and procedures for the financial close and reporting process, such as identifying the roles, responsibilities, methodologies, and review/approval process; we also hope to implement a detailed financial close plan and enhanced and timelier review of manual journal entries, account reconciliations, estimates and judgments.  
 
Finally, it is our intention to engage professionals on an as needed basis to assist the Company in the financial reporting process.  We believe these actions will remediate the material weaknesses by focusing additional attention and resources in our internal accounting functions.  However, the material weaknesses will not be considered remediated until the applicable remedial controls operate for a sufficient period of time and management has concluded, through testing, that these controls are operating effectively and even then, we cannot assure you that this will be sufficient. We may be required to expend additional resources to identify, assess and correct any additional weaknesses in disclosure or internal control. The Company cannot make assurances that it will not identify additional material weaknesses in its internal control over financial reporting in the future.

As of the date of the of this report, we have taken the following steps to address the above-referenced material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting to ensure that all information will be recorded, processed, summarized and reported accurately:

1.  
On August 7, 2009, we filed an amended the 10-K to include the Management’s Report on Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting;
   
2.  
We will continue to educate our management personnel on compliance with the disclosure requirements of the Securities Exchange Act  of 1934 and Regulation S-K; and

3.  
We have increased management oversight of accounting and reporting functions.
 
The presence of these material weaknesses does not mean that any misstatement has occurred in our financial statements, but only that our present controls might not be adequate to detect or prevent a material misstatement in a timely manner.
  
This annual report does not include an attestation report of our registered public accounting firm regarding internal control over financial reporting. Management’s report was not subject to attestation by our registered public accounting firm pursuant to temporary rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission that permit us to provide only management’s report in this annual report.

Fund.com Inc.

Gregory Webster, CEO
Michael Hlavsa, CFO

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
 
There have been no changes in our internal controls over financial reporting that occurred during our fiscal quarter to which this Annual Report on Form 10-K relates that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal controls over financial reporting. 
 
 
58

 
 

We do not have any information required to be disclosed in a report on Form 8-K during the fourth quarter of 2009 that was not reported.
 
 

 
 
59

 
PART III


Executive Officers and Directors

The following table sets forth the name, age and position of each of the members of our board of directors and executive officers as of the date of this report:

Name
 
Age
 
Position(s)
Joseph J. Bianco
  59  
Chairman of the Board of Directors
Gregory Webster
  48  
Chief Executive Officer and Director
Michael Hlavsa
  56  
Chief Financial Officer
Philip Gentile
  57  
Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President
Raul Biancardi
  47  
Director
Ivar Eilertsen
  52  
Director
Keith Laslop
  38  
Director

In connection with the Merger that closed on January 15, 2008, Ms. Rahman resigned as our sole director and officer and the persons listed in the table below became our officers and directors.  As of January 16, 2008, Mr. Klaus replaced Ms. Rahman as our acting Chief Executive Officer and served as such until February 1, 2008.  On February 1, 2008 Mr. Lang replaced Mr. Klaus as our Chief Executive Officer.  On August 6, 2008, Mr. Webster was appointed as our Chief Executive Officer and ceased acting as our President.  In connection therewith, Mr. Lang was appointed as our President and ceased acting as our Chief Executive Officer.

As of January 31, 2009, Mr. Rennick resigned as our Executive Vice President.
 
On February 17, 2009, the Company accepted Raymond Lang’s resignation as one of the Company’s board members and as the Company’s President, effective as of February 12, 2009; he also resigned from his positions with the Company’s subsidiaries. Mr. Lang did not resign in connection with any disagreement with the Company or its management.
 
Effective February 20, 2009, Michael Hlavsa and Darren Rennick also resigned from the Board of Directors, but Mr. Hlavsa is maintaining his position as our Chief Financial Officer.  Neither Mr. Hlavsa nor Mr. Rennick resigned from the Board of Directors in connection with any disagreement with the Company or its management.  In conjunction with the resignations of Messrs Lang, Hlavsa and Rennick, the Board will decrease its size from nine members to six members.  The Board believes that this reduction in size is appropriate to reflect the corporate governance responsibilities and obligations of the Company.

Joseph J. Bianco – Chairman of the Board of Directors
 
Mr Bianco purchased Lotus Performance Cars, Inc. in 1982, which he subsequently sold to General Motors in 1987. In 1990, Mr. Bianco co-founded and became Chief Executive Officer of Alliance Entertainment Corporation. In 1996, Mr. Bianco and his partner sold control of NYSE-Listed Alliance, then the leading independent distributor of CD music in the world, and resumed his private investing activities. In 1998, an investor group led by Mr. Bianco bought the first of several magazine distributors that were consolidated into the Interlink Companies, of which Mr. Bianco was Chairman. Interlink, a leading distributor of magazines to booksellers and other retailers was sold in 2001 to the Source-Interlink Companies. From 1997 to 2000, Mr. Bianco was also Chairman of Cognitive Arts, Inc., a leading creator of educational software, which was purchased from Northwestern University. From 2003 to 2004, he served on the board of directors of Whitewing Environmental, Inc. Mr. Bianco also serves on the Board of several other private corporations as well as two non-profit organizations.  He also currently serves as Chairman and CEO of Florham Consulting Corp., a publicly traded company.  Mr. Bianco graduated from Yale Law School in 1975, where he was an editor of the Yale Law Journal. He became Associate Dean at Cardozo School of Law at Yeshiva University and is the author of two books and various articles.
 
 
60

 
 
Gregory Webster - Chief Executive Officer and Director
 
Mr. Webster brings over 20 years of management experience throughout the financial services, brokerage and insurance industries, including extensive global wealth leadership experience.  Prior to his current position at Fund.com, Mr. Webster was the President and CEO of HSBC Brokerage (USA) Inc., one of the largest banks in the world, where he was responsible for approximately $32.5 billion of client assets. Mr. Webster additionally held a seat on the Board of HSBC Asset Management (Americas) and served as Head of Securities of HSBC North America. In the latter role, Mr. Webster served on the board of directors and oversaw all the wealth management advisory services of HSBC Securities (Canada) Inc. and Merrill-Lynch HSBC (Canada) Inc., and was responsible for trading and execution services for HSBC subsidiaries and international affiliates.  Before joining HSBC in 2000, Mr. Webster led the Guardian Life Insurance Company in the formation and SEC Registration of a newly formed broker/dealer, Park Avenue Securities, LLC. Mr. Webster served as President of Park Avenue Securities, where he managed the securities operations and the distribution of wealth management and insurance products through a field force of approximately 4,000 registered representatives across the country. Prior to Park Avenue, Mr. Webster was the Chief Operating Officer for NYLIFE Securities, Inc., a subsidiary of New York Life Insurance Company, where he managed the wealth management proposition for approximately 8,000 registered representatives nationally. Mr. Webster was previously a Director of Private Client Services at Dreyfus Service Corporation, a subsidiary of Mellon Bank.  Mr. Webster received his B.S. in Marketing from the School of Business from Arizona State University, and a Masters Degree in Business Administration in Finance from Long Island University.

Michael Hlavsa – Chief Financial Officer
 
Mr. Hlavsa is an experienced executive that has over 33 years of combined financial and operational experience. He is both a Certified Public Accountant and a Certified Internal Auditor. He has spent over 18 years working in the United States casino industry. From 2004 to the present, he has been the founder and principal owner of Signature Gaming Management LLC, a consulting firm specializing in advising emerging companies engaged in gaming operations. In 2005, he served as Chief Executive Officer for Titan Cruise Lines, a casino business which operated a 2,000 passenger ship and high speed shuttles. From 2001 to 2004, Mr. Hlavsa was the Chief Executive Officer for SunCruz Casinos, the largest day cruise gaming company in the United States. From 1997 to 2000, Mr. Hlavsa was Managing Partner at Casino Princesa in Miami, Florida where he was responsible for the development and operation of a large mega-yacht gaming vessel. From 1993 to 1997, he served as Chief Financial Officer and Vice President, Midwest region, for Lady Luck Gaming Corporation, a publicly traded company. While at Lady Luck, he participated in that company’s initial public offering of equity and a $185 million debt financing. From 1991 to 1993, Mr. Hlavsa was the Vice President of Finance and Administration for the Sands Hotel and Casino in Las Vegas, Nevada. His first 12 years of gaming experience was in Atlantic City, New Jersey in various audit and finance positions with well-established gaming companies such as Caesars, Tropicana and Trump Plaza. Since March 2007, Mr. Hlavsa has served as Chief Financial Officer and a director of Gerova Financial Group, Ltd. (formerly Asia Special Situation Acquisition Corp.), a publicly traded company. He received a Bachelor of Science degree from Canisius College in Buffalo, New York in 1975.

Philip Gentile – Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President
 
Mr. Gentile has over twenty-five years of experience in the financial services and securities industry. Prior to joining Fund.com, he served in Morgan Stanley’s Global Wealth Management Group as Vice President of Vendor Management Office, where he managed the bank’s technology and operations vendors. Prior to Morgan Stanley, Mr. Gentile was Vice President of Business Operations at Standard & Poor's, Inc., a subsidiary of McGraw-Hill. In addition to working at top-tier financial firms, Mr. Gentile has also owned and operated his own businesses, including CyberVestors where he developed a marketing newsletter for a small brokerage firm utilizing Earnings Surprise as a method of identifying investment opportunities for individual investors. Prior to that, Mr. Gentile was a Senior Vice President and co-founder of Global Information Technologies, a re-distributor of online financial services to brokerage and money management firms who provided aggregation, research and reporting on equities. He began his career as Vice President of Equity Research for Shearson Lehman Brothers, where he managed product development for an institutional service, FINSTAT, which provided research, analysis, back-testing and reporting for equities and mutual funds. Mr. Gentile received his B.S. in Quantitative Analysis and Economics from Manhattan College, and subsequently attended Pace University's MBA Finance Program.

Raul Biancardi - Independent Director / Chairman Audit and Compensation Committee
 
Mr. Biancardi’s career in finance began in 1993 at Morgan Stanley International. He moved to Deutsche Bank as Head of Emerging Markets Equities, and to Lehman Brothers International in 1998, where he served for six years in positions including Head of Fixed Income Prime Brokerage (Europe) and Head of Wealth and Asset Management for Europe/Middle East/Africa. He is currently a senior manager at a leading Middle Eastern bank. Mr. Biancardi holds a Masters Degree in Business Administration from Westminster University in London, and Bachelors Degree in English from Tulane University.
 
 
61

 
 
Ivar Eilertsen - Independent Director / Audit and Compensation Committee
 
Mr. Eilertsen has served since 2006 as the Founding Partner of Harbor Capital Technologies, LLC, a boutique advisory firm focused on financial technology. Prior to founding Harbor Capital, Mr. Eilertsen served as Managing Director and Senior Vice President, Global Accounts for Thomson Financial. Prior to joining Thomson, Mr. Eilertsen served in senior management roles at ADP Brokerage Services Group (now Broadridge), and was CEO, Americas and General Manager of ADP Wilco. Mr. Eilertsen holds a Bachelor of Science Degree from the University of Oslo, Norway.

Keith Laslop – Independent Director /Audit and Compensation Committee
 
Mr. Laslop is a chartered accountant and holds the Chartered Financial Analyst (CFA) accreditation. From 2004 to 2008, Mr. Laslop served as the President of Prolexic Technologies, Inc., a managed digital security service provider, where he was responsible for the growth and financial performance of the company. Since May 2008, Mr. Laslop has served as a director of Gerova Financial Group, Ltd. (formerly Asia Special Situation Acquisition Corp.), a publicly traded company. From 2001 to 2004, he served as the Chief Financial Officer and Business Development Director of Elixir Studios Ltd., a London-based interactive entertainment software developer, where he was responsible for originating and negotiating new development contracts, as well as securing three rounds of capital to fund operations. Prior to Elixir, Mr. Laslop was Director of Business Development EMEA at Inktomi, a public Internet infrastructure software company. He has a background in structuring and negotiating various mergers and acquisitions in London, England and Toronto, Canada. Mr. Laslop earned an Honors Business Administration degree from the University of Western Ontario in 1993 and his Chartered Accountant designation from the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants in 1996. In addition, he earned his Chartered Financial Analyst designation from the Institute of Chartered Financial Analysts in 1999.

Board of Directors
 
All directors will hold office until the next annual meeting of shareholders and until their successors have been duly elected and qualified. Officers are elected by and serve at the discretion of the Board of Directors.

Role of the Board of Directors
 
Pursuant to Delaware law, our business, property and affairs are managed under the direction of the Company’s board of directors. The board has responsibility for establishing broad corporate policies and for the overall performance and direction of Fund.com Inc, but is not involved in day-to-day operations. Members of the board keep informed of the Company’s business by participating in board and committee meetings, by reviewing analyses and reports sent to them regularly, and through discussions with its executive officers.

Advisory Board
 
We do not currently have an advisory board.
 
Compensation of the Board of Directors
 
Directors who are also our employees do not receive additional compensation for serving on the board or its committees. Non-employee directors are not paid any annual cash fee. In addition, directors are entitled to receive options under our stock incentive plan. All directors are reimbursed for their reasonable expenses incurred in attending board meetings. We have procured director’s and officer’s liability insurance.

Board Committees

In June 2008, our board of directors has established the following committees.  The Company intends to have charters for these committees available on our website in the near future.
 
 
62

 
 
Audit Committee

Our audit committee consists of Messrs. Biancardi (chairman of the committee), Eilertsen and Laslop and the Board has determined that each such person is independent, as that term is defined in Section 121 of the NYSE Amex’s Listing Standards and Section 10A(m)(3) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.  Messrs. Biancardi, Eilertsen and Laslop’s qualifications as an audit committee financial expert are described in his respective biography above.  Additionally, our board of directors has determined that Messrs. Biancardi, Eilertsen and Laslop each qualify as an “audit committee financial expert,” as that term is defined in Item 407 of Regulation S-K and that each is an independent director as set forth in Section 10A-3 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended..
 
The audit committee reviews the professional services and independence of our independent registered public accounting firm and our accounts, procedures and internal control. The audit committee selects our independent registered public accounting firm, reviews and approves the scope of the annual audit, reviews with the independent public accounting firm our annual audit and annual consolidated financial statements, reviews with management the status of internal accounting control, evaluates problem areas having a potential financial impact on us that may be brought to the committee’s attention by management, the independent registered public accounting firm or the board of directors, and evaluates all of our public financial reporting documents.

Compensation Committee
 
Our compensation committee consists of Messrs. Biancardi (chairman of the committee), Eilertsen and Laslop. The principal function of the compensation committee is to review the compensation payable to our officers and directors.

Director Independence
 
During fiscal 2009 and through the present, we were not and are not required to comply with the director independence requirements of any securities exchange.  In determining whether our directors are independent however, the board of directors applies the requirements for   “independent directors” as defined in the rules and regulations of the NYSE Amex (formerly known as the American Stock Exchange).  The Company’s board of directors determined that Messrs. Biancardi, Eilertsen and Laslop are independent.

Family Relationships
 
There are no family relationships among our executive officers and directors.
 
Involvement in Certain Legal Proceedings.

None of our officers or directors have, during the last five years: (i) been convicted in or is currently subject to a pending a criminal proceeding; (ii) been a party to a civil proceeding of a judicial or administrative body of competent jurisdiction and as a result of such proceeding was or is subject to a judgment, decree or final order enjoining future violations of, or prohibiting or mandating activities subject to any federal or state securities or banking laws including, without limitation, in any way limiting involvement in any business activity, or finding any violation with respect to such law, nor (iii) has any bankruptcy petition been filed by or against the business of which such person was an executive officer or a general partner, whether at the time of the bankruptcy of for the two years prior thereto.
 
Compliance with Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act

Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, requires our directors, executive officers, and shareholders holding more than 10% of our outstanding common stock, to file with the Securities and Exchange Commission initial reports of ownership and reports of changes in beneficial ownership of our common stock. Executive officers, directors and greater-than-10% shareholders are required by SEC regulations to furnish us with copies of all Section 16(a) reports they file. To our knowledge, based solely on review of the copies of such reports furnished to us for the year ended December 31, 2009, the Section 16(a) reports required to be filed by our executive officers, directors and greater-than-10% shareholders were filed on a timely basis.
 
 
63

 
 
Code of Ethics
 
In June 2008, the Company adopted a Code of Ethics and Business Conduct.  This Code provides rules and procedures to help the Company’s employees, officers and directors recognize and respond to situations that present ethical issues.  This Code applies to all of our employees, officers and directors, wherever they are located and whether they work for the Company on a full or part-time basis.  Compliance with this code is mandatory and those who violate the standards in this Code will be subject to disciplinary action.


Summary Compensation Table
 
The following table sets forth certain information concerning the compensation of the chief executive officer and certain of other executive officers of the Company whose aggregate cash compensation exceeded $100,000 (other than the principal executive officer) for each of the last two fiscal years.

Some of the officers listed below did not work for us in any capacity during 2008 or 2009, or only worked for a portion of such years; however, we are required to include information covering our last two fiscal years for each of the officers listed below.  Accordingly, we strongly advise you to read the footnotes to the table, which explain the time of service and therefore why such person may not have received any compensation in certain years.

Name and Principal Position
 
Year
 
Salary
($)
   
Bonus
($)
   
Stock Awards
($)
   
Option Awards
($)
 
(a)
 
(b)
 
(c)
   
(d)
   
(e)
   
(f)
 
                             
Ms. Ahkee Rahman, Former CEO (1)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Raymond Lang, Former President (2)
 
2009
    66,433       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    229,167 (3)     -0-       -0-       411,760  
                                     
Mr. Gregory Webster, Chief Executive Officer (4)
 
2009
    250,000       -0-       -0-       102,500  
   
2008
    208,833       -0-       -0-       610,732 (5)
                                     
Mr. Michael Hlavsa, Chief Financial Officer
 
2009
    120,000       -0-       -0-       27,500  
   
2008
    110,000       -0-       -0-       29,096 (6)
                                     
Mr. Philip Gentile, COO (7)
 
2009
    250,000       -0-       -0-       27,500  
   
2008
    208,333       -0-       -0-       442,519  
                                     
Mr. Daniel Klaus, Former CEO
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       202,500       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Lucas Mann, Former Chief Marketing Officer
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       202,500       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Darren Rennick, Former Executive Vice President
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Richard Carrigan (8)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
 
 
64

 

 Name and Principal Position
 
Year
 
Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)
   
Non-Qualified
Deferred Compensation
Earnings
($)
   
All other
Compensation
   
Total
($)
 
(a)
 
(b)
 
(g)
   
(h)
   
(i)
   
(j)
 
                             
Ms. Ahkee Rahman, Former CEO (1)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Raymond Lang, Former President (2)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       100,000       166,433  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       3,899       644,826  
                                     
Mr. Gregory Webster, Chief Executive Officer (4)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       352,500  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       3,190       822,255  
                                     
Mr. Michael Hlavsa, Chief Financial Officer
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       147,500  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       139,096  
                                     
Mr. Philip Gentile, COO (7)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       277,500  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       3,190       654,042  
                                     
Mr. Daniel Klaus, Former CEO
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       202,500  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Lucas Mann, Former Chief Marketing Officer
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       202,500  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Darren Rennick, Former Executive Vice President
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
                                     
Mr. Richard Carrigan (8)
 
2009
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  
   
2008
    -0-       -0-       -0-       -0-  

(1) Ms. Rahman resigned as our sole officer on January 15, 2008 in connection with the Merger.

(2) Mr. Lang served as our CEO and one of our directors from February 1, 2008 to August 6, 2008 and as our President from August 6, 2008 to February 12, 2009. In December 2007, Mr. Lang received a stock option grant to purchase 1,938,087 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $2.30 per share, pursuant to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan.
 
 (3)  Mr. Lang resigned as President and a Director, effective as of February 12, 2009.  As a result of his resignation and pursuant to his original employment agreement, Mr. Lang entered into a release agreement with the Company.  The Release Agreement entitled Mr. Lang to receive cash payments equal to nine months’ of his base salary (approximately $187,500); the Company paid Mr. Lang $50,000 after the Release Agreement was signed and per a revision to the Release Agreement paid an additional $100,000 in 2009.   The release agreement also extended Mr. Lang’s time to exercise his vested options to purchase 484,522 shares of our common stock with an exercise price of $2.30 per share until the first anniversary of his separation which expired on February 12, 2010. The Company also agreed to pay Mr. Lang all of his outstanding unpaid and approved expenses, which total approximately $860.  In exchange for payment of the severance and expenses, and the modification to the options, the Company is forever released from any and all claims Mr. Lang may have against the Company.

(4) Mr. Webster served as our President from March 4, 2008 to August 6, 2008, and has been serving as our Chief Executive Officer and one of our directors since August 6, 2008.
 
 
65

 
 
(5) In March 2008, Mr. Webster received a stock option grant to purchase 1,000,000 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $3.50 per share, pursuant to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan.  On August 6, 2008, the Board appointed Gregory Webster, President of the Company, as Chief Executive Officer of the Company.   The amendment to Mr. Webster’s agreement to appoint him as CEO, also includes an additional option grant to purchase 653,000 shares of the Company’s Class A Common Stock at a $3.25 price per share based upon the closing price on the OTC Bulletin Board as of August 5, 2008. The first 153,000 shares will vest upon the grant of the options, with 25% of the remainder vesting on March 1, 2008 and the balance vesting quarterly over the following 36 months. In the event of a change of control, vesting will accelerate twelve months.

In October 2009, we issued 100,000 restricted shares of our Class A common stock to Gregory Webster which was approved by our board of directors on May 14, 2009 under our Amended and Restated 2007 Stock Incentive Plan as compensation for services performed and to be performed on behalf of our company.  In addition, on May 14, 2009 our board of directors approved the issuance of an additional 150,000 restricted shares of our Class A common stock to Gregory Webster as compensation for services performed and to be performed on behalf of our company which vest as follows: (i) 75,000 on May 14, 2010; and (ii) 75,000 on May 14, 2011.  

In October 2009, Mr. Webster received a stock option grant to purchase 750,000 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $0.60 per share for a period of 5 years from the date of grant which was May 14, 2010.  The Options vest as follows: (i) 1/3rd on May 14, 2009; (ii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2010; and (iii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2011.

(6) Mr Hlavsa has been the Chief Financial Officer since our inception and has served as a Director until February 20, 2009.   In December 2007, Mr. Hlavsa received a stock option grant to purchase 130,024 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $2.30 per share, pursuant to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan.

In October 2009, Mr. Hlavsa received a stock option grant to purchase 250,000 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $0.60 per share for a period of 5 years from the date of grant which was May 14, 2010.  The Options vest as follows: (i) 1/3rd on May 14, 2009; (ii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2010; and (iii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2011.

(7) Mr. Gentile has served as our Chief Operating Officer and Executive Vice President of Business Development since March 4, 2008.  In March 2008, Mr. Gentile received a stock option grant to purchase 1,000,000 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $3.50 per share, pursuant to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan.

In October 2009, Mr. Gentile received a stock option grant to purchase 250,000 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $0.60 per share for a period of 5 years from the date of grant which was May 14, 2010.  The Options vest as follows: (i) 1/3rd on May 14, 2009; (ii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2010; and (iii) 1/3rd on May 14, 2011.

(8) This reflects salary paid to Mr. Carrigan as the sole employee of an operating subsidiary of Eastern Services Holdings for 2007.

Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End

The following table sets forth information with respect to stock awards and grants of options to purchase our common stock to the named executive officers during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009.

Name
 
Number of Securities
Underlying Unexercised
Options
(#)
 
Equity Incentive
Plan Awards:
Number of Securities
Underlying Unexercised
Unearned Options
(#)
 
Equity Incentive
Plan Awards:
Number of Securities
Underlying Unexercised
Unearned Options
(#)
 
Option Exercise Price
($)
 
Option Expiration Date
(a)
 
(b)
 
(c)
 
(d)
 
(e)
 
(f)
                     
Ahkee Rahman
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Raymond Lang
 
-0-
 
484,522
 
-0-
 
2.30
 
-0-
Gregory Webster
 
-0-
 
2,403,000
 
-0-
 
2.53
 
-0-
Michael Hlavsa
 
-0-
 
388,024
 
-0-
 
1.20
 
-0-
Philip Gentile
 
-0-
 
1,250,000
 
-0-
 
2.92
 
-0-
Daniel Klaus
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Lucas Mann
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Darren Rennick
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Richard Carrigan
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
  
 
66

 
 
Name
 
Number of Shares or Units
of Stock That
Have Not Vested
(#)
 
Market Value of Shares
of Units of Stock That
Have Not Vested
($)
 
Equity Incentive
Plan Awards:
Number of Unearned Shares,
Units or Other Rights That
Have Not Vested
(#)
 
Equity Incentive
Plan Awards:
Market or Payout Value of
Unearned Shares, Units
or Other Rights That
Have Not Vested
(a)
 
(g)
 
(h)
 
(i)
 
(j)
                 
Ahkee Rahman
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Raymond Lang
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Gregory Webster
 
150,000
 
292,500
 
-0-
 
-0-
Michael Hlavsa
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Philip Gentile
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Daniel Klaus
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Lucas Mann
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Darren Rennick
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Richard Carrigan
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
Director Compensation

The following table sets forth with respect to the named directors, compensation information inclusive of equity awards and payments made in the year end December 31, 2009.

Name
 
Fees  Earned or Paid in Cash
($)
 
Stock Awards
($)
 
Option Awards
($)
 
Non-Equity incentive Plan Compensation
($)
(a)
 
(b)
 
(c)
 
(d)
 
(e)
                 
Daniel Klaus
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Lucas Mann
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Ivar Eilersten
 
$15,000
 
-0-
 
$5,500
 
-0-
Raul Biancardi
 
$15,000
 
-0-
 
$33,000
 
-0-
Keith Laslop
 
$15,000
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
Darren Rennick
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
-0-
                 

Name
 
Change in Pension Value and
Nonqualified Deferred
Compensation Earnings
 
All other Compensation
($)
 
Total
($)
(a)
 
(f)
 
(g)
 
(h)
             
Daniel Klaus
 
-0-
 
-0- (1)
 
-0-
Lucas Mann
 
-0-
 
-0- (1)
 
-0-
Ivar Eilertsen
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
$20,500
Raul Biancardi
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
$48,000
Keith Laslop
 
-0-
 
-0-
 
$15,000
Darren Rennick
 
-0-
 
-0- (2)
 
-0-
             
 
 
67

 
 
(1) Mr. Klaus and Mr. Mann will receive a consulting fee for services provided to the Company of $300,000 beginning from March 2008 pursuant to a Consulting Agreement between the Company and Fabric Group LLC (“Fabric”), and a one time fee of $55,000. Fabric is wholly-owned by Mr. Klaus and Mr. Mann is a consultant working for Fabric, but shares in the fees received pursuant to the consulting agreement.  The Fabric Consulting agreement has been renewed pursuant to the terms of the agreement as of March 9, 2009. The Fabric Consulting agreement was mutually terminated and Fabric has agreed to accept in lieu of payment of $405,000, a total of 1,928,570 shares equally distributed to Lucas Mann and Daniel Klaus at 964,285 each.
 
(2) Pursuant to a one year Consulting Agreement between the Company and MKL Consulting Ltd. (“MKL”), which is wholly-owned and managed by Mr. Rennick, beginning on March 2008, MKL received a $150,000 consulting fee for services provided to the Company under the consulting agreement which was not renewed in 2009.
 
We intend to pay the outside Directors $15,000 per year plus reimburse them for any out of pockets expenses in connection with attending board meetings.  Additionally, outside directors will receive grants of incentive stock options pursuant to our 2007 Equity Incentive Plan.

Employment Agreements
 
We have employment agreements with Michael Hlavsa, our Chief Financial Officer; Gregory Webster our current Chief Executive Officer; and Philip Gentile, our Chief Operating Officer. We had an employment agreement with Raymond Lang, our previous Chief Executive Officer and President, until his resignation on February 12, 2009.
 
Mr. Lang. On December 20, 2007 we entered into an employment agreement with Raymond Lang. Pursuant to the agreement, beginning February 1, 2008, Mr. Lang began to serve as our Chief Executive Officer. Unless terminated earlier, the term of the agreement is scheduled to expire on February 1, 2011. Mr. Lang receives a salary of no less than $250,000 per annum and will be eligible to participate in any bonus or incentive compensation plans that we establish for senior executives. We pay the premium for health care coverage for him and his dependents. He received a stock option grant to purchase 1,938,087 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $2.30 per share. The option vests over four years, with 25% vesting on the first anniversary and the balance vesting with respect to an additional 1/12th of the shares following each three months of continuous service thereafter. In the event his employment is terminated by us without “Cause” or he resigns with “Good Reason” as these terms are defined in the employment agreement, we will be obligated to pay to him (i) his base salary though the date of termination, (ii) any bonus earned in the previous year but not yet paid, (iii) any accrued vacation through the date of termination, (iv) pro rata bonus for the year of termination, calculated and payable after year-end, and (v) a lump-sum amount equal to 9 months’ base salary. The Employment Agreement with Mr. Lang is incorporated by reference in its entirety from the Form 8-K dated January 17, 2008.
 
Mr. Lang resigned as President and a Director as of February 12, 2009.  As a result of his resignation and pursuant to his original employment agreement, Mr. Lang entered into a release agreement with the Company.  The Release Agreement entitled Mr. Lang to receive cash payments equal to nine months’ of his base salary (approximately $187,500); the Company paid Mr. Lang $50,000 after the Release Agreement was signed and per a revision to the Release Agreement paid  an additional $100,000 in 2009   The release agreement also extended Mr. Lang’s time to exercise his vested options to purchase 484,522 shares of our common stock with an exercise price of $2.30 per share until the first anniversary of his separation which expired on February 12, 2010. The Company also agreed to pay Mr. Lang all of his outstanding unpaid and approved expenses, which total approximately $860.  In exchange for payment of the severance and expenses, and the modification to the options, the Company is forever released from any and all claims Mr. Lang may have against the Company.
 
Mr. Hlavsa. On October 30, 2007 we entered into an at-will employment agreement with Mr. Hlavsa.  Under the agreement, Mr. Hlavsa was originally schedule to commence employment on November 15, 2007; however, he did not commence employment until February 1, 2008.  Mr. Hlavsa will receive an annual base salary of $120,000 per annum.  In addition, Mr. Hlavsa is eligible for a performance bonus of up to $120,000 subject to the achievement of reasonable performance metrics, as determined by the Board.  He received a stock option grant to purchase 138,024 shares of our Class A Common Stock with an exercise price of $2.30. The option vests over four years, with 25% vesting on the first anniversary and the balance vesting with respect to an additional 1/12th of the shares following each three months of continuous service thereafter. The Employment Agreement with Mr. Hlavsa is incorporated by reference in its entirety on Form 8-K dated January 17, 2008. As of the date of this Report, we owe Mr. Hlavsa approximately $90,000 under his employment agreement for 2009.
 
 
68

 
 
Mr. Webster. On March 4, 2008 we entered into an employment agreement with Mr. Webster that ends March 1, 2011, but may be automatically renewed for an additional one (1) year term unless either party provides ninety (90) days written notice prior to the end of the term. The Employment Agreement permits Mr. Webster to resign at any time upon 90 days written notice and for the Company to terminate Mr. Webster’s employment at any time. Mr. Webster will receive nine months severance if he resigns for Good Reason or is terminated without Cause (each as defined in the Employment Agreement). His annual base salary is a minimum of $250,000, subject to review for increase at least annually; however Mr. Webster agreed to reduce his salary for 2009 until our cash flow position improves, the terms of which reduction are still being negotiated. He is also entitled to participate in bonus, incentive and health care benefit plans maintained by the Company from time to time. In connection with his employment, Mr. Webster was granted an option to purchase 1,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock at $3.50 per share. The option vests over four years, with 25% vesting on the first anniversary and the balance vesting quarterly over the following 36 months. In the event of a change of control, vesting will accelerate twelve months, and if Mr. Webster’s service is terminated by the Company other than for Cause prior to the first anniversary, vesting will accelerate to the first anniversary. The Employment Agreement with Mr. Webster is incorporated by reference in its entirety Form 8-K filed March 10, 2008.
 
On August 6, 2008, the Board appointed Gregory Webster, President of the Company, as Chief Executive Officer of the Company. In conjunction with his appointment, he was removed as President and from all other positions at the Company. He was also appointed as Chief Executive Officer of each of the Company’s subsidiaries, and was removed as President and from all other positions at the subsidiaries. Mr. Webster was also appointed as a member of the Board of Directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. In connection with his appointment as CEO, we amended his employment agreement, pursuant to which Mr. Webster was granted an additional option to purchase 653,000 shares of the Company’s Class A Common Stock at a $3.25 price per share based upon the closing price on the OTC Bulletin Board as of August 5, 2008. The first 153,000 shares will vest upon the grant of the options, with 25% of the remainder vesting on March 1, 2008 and the balance vesting quarterly over the following 36 months. In the event of a change of control, vesting will accelerate twelve months. As of the date of this Report, we owe Mr. Webster approximately $205,000 under his employment agreement for 2009.
 
Mr. Gentile. Mr. Gentile is employed pursuant to an Employment Agreement dated as of March 4, 2008, which is substantially identical in form to that of Mr. Webster’s, which is described above. In connection with his employment, Mr. Gentile was granted an option to purchase 1,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock at $3.50 per share. The option vests over four years, with 25% vesting on the first anniversary and the balance vesting quarterly over the following 36 months. In the event of a change of control, vesting will accelerate twelve months, and if Mr. Gentile’s service is terminated by the Company other than for Cause prior to the first anniversary, vesting will accelerate to the first anniversary. The Employment Agreement with Mr. Gentile is incorporated by reference in its entirety herein from the Current Report on Form 8-K filed March 10, 2008. As of the date of this Report, we owe Mr. Gentile approximately $200,000 under his employment agreement for 2009.

Amended and Restated 2007 Stock Incentive Plan

The following is a summary of the Company’s Amended and Restated 2007 Stock Incentive Plan (the “Plan”).

Purpose. The purpose of the Plan is to promote the long-term success of the Company by (a) encouraging selected employees, consultants and directors to focus on critical long-range objectives, (b) encouraging the attraction and retention of employees, consultants and directors with exceptional qualifications, and (c) linking employees, consultants and directors directly to stockholder interests through increased stock ownership.  The Plan seeks to achieve this purpose by providing for awards in the form of restricted shares, stock units, options (which may constitute incentive stock options or non-statutory stock options) or stock appreciation rights.

Stock Subject to the Plan. Currently a total of 10,000,000 shares of Class A common stock (the “Common Stock”) may be issued under the Plan, subject to adjustments. The Company may use shares held in treasury in lieu of authorized but unissued shares. If any award expires or terminates, the shares subject to such award shall again be available for purposes of the Plan. Any shares used by the participant as payment to satisfy a purchase price related to an award, and any shares withheld by the Company to satisfy an applicable tax-withholding obligation, shall again be available for purposes of the Plan.

Administration of the Plan. The Plan is administered by the Compensation Committee, all of the members of which are independent as required by law. The Compensation Committee has sole discretion over determining individuals eligible to participate in the Plan and the time or times at which awards will be granted and the number of shares, if applicable, which will be granted under an award. Subject to certain limitations, the Compensation Committee’s power and authority includes, but is not limited to, the ability to interpret the plan, to establish rules and regulations for carrying out the plan and to amend or rescind any rules previously established, to determine the terms and provisions of the award agreements and to make all other determinations necessary or advisable for the administration of the plan.
 
 
69

 
 
Eligible Persons. Only employees shall be eligible for the grant of incentive stock options. Only employees, consultants and outside directors shall be eligible for the grant of non-statutory stock options, restricted shares, stock units or stock appreciation rights.

Grant of Awards. The types of awards that may be granted under the Plan are stock options (either incentive stock options or non-qualified stock options), stock appreciation rights, performance-based awards, as well as other stock-based awards. Awards are evidenced by an agreement and an award recipient has no rights as a stockholder with respect to any securities covered by an award until the date the recipient becomes a holder of record of the Common Stock.

On the date of the grant, the exercise price must equal at least 100% of the fair market value in the case of incentive stock options, or 110% of the fair market value with respect to optionees who own at least 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock. The fair market value is determined by computing the arithmetic mean of the high and low stock prices on a given determination date. This price needs not be uniform for all recipients of non-qualified stock options and must not be less than 100% of the fair market value. The exercise price on the date of grant is determined by the Compensation Committee in the case of non-qualified stock options. Options granted under the plan will vest as provided by the Compensation Committee at the time of the grant. The Compensation Committee may provide for accelerated vesting or termination in exchange for cash of any outstanding awards or the issuance of substitute awards upon consummation of a “change in control”. The options expire on the date determined by the Compensation Committee but may not extend more than ten years from the grant date.

For purposes of the Plan, a “change in control” is defined as (i) the purchase or other acquisition (other than from the Company) by any person, entity or group of persons, within the meaning of § 13(d) or § 14(d) of the Exchange Act (excluding, for this purpose, the Company or its subsidiaries or any employee benefit plan of the Company or its subsidiaries), of beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 51% or more of either the outstanding shares of the Common Stock or the combined voting power of the Company’s outstanding voting securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors, each as of the time the Stock Incentive Plan was entered into; or (ii) individuals who constituted the Board of Directors at the time the Stock Incentive Plan was entered into cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the Board of Directors, except for the election of any person who becomes a director subsequent to such date whose election, or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders, was approved by a vote of at least a majority of the directors then comprising the incumbent Board of Directors (other than an individual whose initial assumption of office is in connection with an actual or threatened election contest relating to the election of directors); or (iii) approval by the Company’s stockholders of a reorganization, merger or consolidation, in each case with respect to which persons who were the stockholders of the Company immediately prior to such reorganization, merger or consolidation do not, immediately thereafter, own more than 50% of, respectively, the Common Stock and the combined voting power entitled to vote generally in the election of directors of the reorganized, merged or consolidated corporation’s then outstanding voting securities, or of a liquidation or dissolution of the Company or of the sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company.

Stock appreciation rights granted under the plan are subject to the same terms and restrictions as the option grants and may be granted independent of, or in connection with, the grant of options. The Compensation Committee determines the exercise price of stock appreciation rights. A stock appreciation right granted independent of an option entitles the participant to payment in an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of a share of the Common Stock on the exercise date over the exercise price per share, times the number of stock appreciation rights exercised. A stock appreciation right granted in connection with an option entitles the participant to surrender an unexercised option and to receive in exchange an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of a share of the Common Stock over the exercise price per share for the option, times the number of shares covered by the option which is surrendered. Fair market value is determined in the same manner as it is determined for options.

The Compensation Committee may also grant awards of stock, restricted stock and other awards valued in whole or in part by reference to the fair market value of the Common Stock. These stock-based awards, in the discretion of the Compensation Committee, may be, among other things, subject to completion of a specified period of service, the occurrence of an event or the attainment of performance objectives. Additionally, the Compensation Committee may grant awards of cash, in values to be determined by the Compensation Committee. If any awards are in excess of $1,000,000 such that Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code applies, the committee may, in its discretion, alter its compensation practices to ensure that compensation deductions are permitted.
 
 
70

 
 
Awards granted under the plan are generally not transferable by the participant except by will or the laws of descent and distribution, and each award is exercisable, during the lifetime of the participant, only by the participant or his or her guardian or legal representative, unless permitted by the committee.

Amendment. The plan may be amended, altered, suspended or terminated by the administrator at any time. The Company may not alter the rights and obligations under any award granted before amendment of the plan without the consent of the affected participant. Unless terminated sooner, the plan will terminate automatically on December 27, 2017.

Federal Income Tax Consequences of Awards

The following is a summary of the U.S. federal income tax consequences that generally will arise with respect to awards granted under the plan and with respect to the sale of Common Stock acquired under the plan. The federal tax laws may change and the federal, state and local tax consequences for any participant will depend upon his or her individual circumstances. The tax consequences for any particular individual may be different.
 
Incentive Stock Options. Some options may constitute “incentive stock options” within the meaning of Section 422 of the Code. If the Company grants an incentive stock option, the recipient is not required to recognize income upon the grant of the incentive stock option, and the Company will not be allowed to take a deduction. Similarly, when a recipient exercises any incentive stock options, provided he or she has not ceased to be an employee of the Company and all affiliates for more than three months before the date of exercise, such employee will not be required to recognize income, and the Company will not be allowed to take a deduction. For purposes of the alternative minimum tax, however, the amount by which the aggregate fair market value of Common Stock acquired on exercise of an incentive stock option exceeds the exercise price of that option generally will be an adjustment included in alternative minimum taxable income for the year in which the incentive stock option is exercised. The Code imposes an alternative minimum tax on a taxpayer whose tentative minimum tax, as defined in Section 55(b) (1) of the Code, exceeds the taxpayer’s regular tax.

Additional tax consequences will depend upon how long the recipient holds the shares of Common Stock received after exercising the incentive stock options. If the shares are held for more than two years from the date of grant and one year from the date of exercise of the option, upon disposition of the shares, any gain upon the subsequent sale of the Common Stock will be taxed as a long-term capital gain or loss. If the recipient disposes of shares acquired upon exercise of an incentive stock option which shares were held for two years or less from the date of grant or one year or less from the date of exercise (“Disqualifying Disposition”), the recipient generally will recognize ordinary income in the year of the Disqualifying Disposition.

To the extent that a recipient recognizes ordinary income, the Company is allowed to take a deduction. In addition, a recipient must recognize as short-term or long-term capital gain, depending on whether the holding period for the shares exceeds one year, any amount that is realized upon disposition of those shares which exceeds the fair market value of those shares on the date of exercise of the option.

Non-Qualified Stock Options. If a recipient receives a non-qualified stock option, he or she will not recognize income at the time of the grant of the stock option, nor will the Company be entitled to a deduction. However, such person will recognize ordinary income upon the exercise of the non-qualified stock option. The amount of ordinary income recognized equals the difference between (a) the fair market value of the stock on the date of exercise and (b) the amount paid for the stock. The Company will be entitled to a deduction in the same amount. The ordinary income recognized will be subject to applicable tax withholding by the Company. When the shares are sold, any difference between the sales price and the basis (i.e., the amount paid for the stock plus the ordinary income recognized) will be treated as a capital gain or loss, depending on the holding period of the shares.

Performance-Based Awards/Stock Appreciation Rights. An award recipient generally will not recognize taxable income upon the grant of performance-based awards or stock appreciation rights. Instead, such person will recognize as ordinary income, and the Company will have as a corresponding deduction, any cash delivered and the fair market value of any Common Stock delivered in payment of an amount due under the performance award or stock appreciation right. The ordinary income recognized will be subject to applicable tax withholding.

Upon selling any Common Stock received by a recipient in payment of an amount due under a performance award or stock appreciation right, such recipient generally will recognize a capital gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the sale price of the Common Stock and the tax basis in the Common Stock, depending on the holding period for the shares.
 
 
71

 
 
Other Stock-Based Awards. The tax consequences associated with any other stock-based award granted under the Plan will vary depending on the specific terms of the award, including whether the award has a readily ascertainable fair market value, whether or not the award is subject to forfeiture provisions or restrictions on transfer, the nature of the property under the award, the applicable holding period and the recipient’s tax basis.

Income Tax Rates on Capital Gain and Ordinary Income.  Under current tax law, short-term capital gain and ordinary income will be taxable at a maximum federal rate of 35%. Phaseouts of personal exemptions and reductions of allowable itemized deductions at higher levels of income may result in slightly higher effective tax rates. Ordinary compensation income generally will also be subject to the Medicare tax and, under certain circumstances, a social security tax. On the other hand, the relevant long-term capital gain will be taxable at a maximum federal rate of 15%.

Effect of Section 162(m) of the Code. Pursuant to Section 162(m) of the Code, the Company may not deduct compensation of more than $1,000,000 that is paid in a taxable year to an individual who, on the last day of the taxable year, is the Company’s chief executive officer or among one of its four other highest compensated officers for that year. The deduction limit, however, does not apply to certain types of compensation, including qualified performance-based compensation. Compensation attributable to incentive stock options and non-qualified stock options granted under the Plan could be treated as qualified performance-based compensation and therefore not be subject to the deduction limit. In addition, the Compensation Committee may structure certain performance-based awards utilizing the performance criteria set forth in the Plan so that payments under such awards may likewise be treated as qualified performance-based compensation.

Limitation of Liability and Indemnification

The Company's directors and executive officers are indemnified as provided by the Delaware General Corporation Law and the Company's Bylaws. Limitation on Liability and Indemnification of Directors and Officers under Delaware General Corporation Law a director or officer is generally not individually liable to the corporation or its shareholders for any damages as a result of any act or failure to act in his capacity as a director or officer, unless it is proven that:
 
1. his act or failure to act constituted a breach of his fiduciary duties as a director or officer; and
2. his breach of those duties involved intentional misconduct, fraud or a knowing violation of law.
 
This provision is intended to afford directors and officers protection against and to limit their potential liability for monetary damages resulting from suits alleging a breach of the duty of care by a director or officer. As a consequence of this provision, stockholders of ours will be unable to recover monetary damages against directors or officers for action taken by them that may constitute negligence or gross negligence in performance of their duties unless such conduct falls within one of the foregoing exceptions. The provision, however, does not alter the applicable standards governing a director's or officer's fiduciary duty and does not eliminate or limit our right or any stockholder to obtain an injunction or any other type of non-monetary relief in the event of a breach of fiduciary duty.
 
As permitted by Delaware law, our By-Laws include a provision which provides for indemnification of a director or officer by us against expenses, judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement of claims against the director or officer arising from the fact that he was an officer or director, provided that the director or officer acted in good faith and in a manner he or she believed to be in or not opposed to our best interests. We have purchased insurance under a policy that insures both our company and our officers and directors against exposure and liability normally insured against under such policies, including exposure on the indemnities described above.
 
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, we have been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling the Company pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Company has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission, such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act of 1933 and is, therefore, unenforceable.
 
 
72

 
 

Securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans.  Please see Part II, Item 5: “Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities” above.

The following tables set forth certain information known to us with respect to beneficial ownership of our Common Stock as of March 31, 2010, by:

·      
each person known by us to own beneficially more than 5% of the Company’s outstanding Common Stock;
·      
each of the Company’s directors;
·      
each named executive officer; and
·      
all of the Company’s directors and executive officers as a group.

Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC and generally includes voting or investment power over securities. The table below includes the number of shares underlying options and warrants that are currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of March 31, 2010. It is therefore based on 69,465,905 and 5,462,665 shares of Class A common stock and Class B common stock outstanding as of March 31, 2010, respectively. Shares of Common Stock subject to options and warrants that are currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of March 31, 2010 are considered outstanding and beneficially owned by the person holding the options or warrants for the purposes of computing beneficial ownership of that person but are not treated as outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of any other person. To our knowledge, except as set forth in the footnotes to this table and subject to applicable community property laws, each person named in the table has sole voting and investment power with respect to the shares set forth opposite such person’s name. Except as otherwise indicated, the address of each of the persons in this table is 14 Wall Street, 20th Floor, New York, New York 10005.

   
Class A Common Stock
Shares %
   
Class B Common Stock
Shares %
   
% Total Voting
Power (1)
 
Daniel Klaus
    4,526,301       6.52 %     0       0       3.65 %
                                         
Lucas Mann
    4,526,301       6.52 %     0       0       3.65 %
                                         
COS Capital Partners I LLC
    9,047,619       13.02 %     0       0       7.29 %
                                         
Michael Hlavsa
    152,262       *       0       0       *  
                                         
Gregory Webster
    1,152,750       1.66 %     0       0       *  
                                         
Philip Gentile
    583,250       *       0       0       *  
                                         
Joseph J. Bianco
    0       0       0       0       0  
                                         
Ivar Eilertsen
    224,900       *       0       0       *  
                                         
Keith Laslop
    104,150       *       0       0       *  
                                         
Raul Biancardi
    266,650       *       0       0       *  
                                         
Equities Media Acquisition Corp Inc. (2)
    0       0       3,462,665       63.4 %     27.90 %
                                         
Barry Feiner, Esq. as Escrow Agent
    0       0       2,000,000       36.6 %     16.12 %
                                         
All officers and directors as a group (7 persons)
    2,483,962       3.58 %     0       0       2.00 %
 
* Less than 1%.

(1)
Percentage total voting power represents voting power with respect to all shares of our Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock, as a single class. Each holder of Class B Common Stock is entitled to 10 votes per share of Class B Common Stock and each holder of Class A Common Stock is entitled to one vote per share of Class A Common Stock on all matters submitted to our stockholders for a vote. The Class A Common Stock and Class B Common Stock vote together as a single class on all matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders, except as may otherwise be required by law. The Class B Common Stock is convertible at any time by the holder into shares of Class A common stock on a share-for-share basis.
 
(2)
The name of the party who has the power to vote and share power to dispose of the shares held by Equities Media Acquisition Corp Inc. is Arne van Roon.  He disclaims beneficial ownership of the securities held by such entity, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein. The address Equities Media Acquisition Corp Inc. is World Trade Centre Lugano-Agno Switzerland.
 
 
73

 
 
Changes in Control
 
Pursuant to the Agreement and Plan of Merger with Fund.com Inc. we issued approximately 37,112,345 shares of our Class A Common Stock and 6,387,665 shares of our Class B Common Stock to former shareholders of Fund.com Inc., representing 87% of our outstanding Class A Common Stock and 100% of our Class B Common Stock following the merger. Therefore, the closing of the merger caused a change in control.
 

Prior to the Merger and as of December 31, 2009, there are no material relationships between us and our current directors and officers.
 
On March 4, 2008, we entered into a Consulting Agreement with Fabric Group, LLC (“Fabric”). Fabric is wholly-owned and managed by the chairman, director and former Chief Executive Officer of the Company.  Under the Consulting Agreement, Fabric will receive an annual base fee of $300,000, in return for strategic consulting services provided by both the Chairman and the Chief Marketing Officer of the Company in the areas of business development, product marketing and online strategy and for performance of other duties as requested from time to time by the Board.  In addition, pursuant to the Consulting Agreement, Fabric will receive a onetime fee of $55,000 for services previously rendered to the Company.  This agreement has been mutually terminated and Fabric has agreed to accept in lieu of payment of $405,000, a total of 1,928,570 shares equally distributed to Lucas Mann and Daniel Klaus at 964,285 each
 
We were party to a consulting agreement with MKL Consulting Ltd., a consulting firm owned by Darren Rennick, one of our former directors.  Pursuant to this agreement, we paid MKL $12,500 per month for the consulting services they provided to the Company.  However, the consulting agreement expired in February 2009 and we did not renew it.
  
As a further inducement to the IP Global to make available the line of credit, Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann, two shareholders of the Company and members of the board of directors at the time, also sold to the lenders or their designees (in equal amounts) a total of 2,000,000 of their shares of Class A common stock of the Company at a price of $0.25 per share, payable on the basis of $50,000 in cash and the $450,000 balance evidenced by two notes of $225,000 each payable in equal monthly installments through December 31, 2009.  In addition, Messrs. Klaus and Mann each contributed 500,000 of their Company shares to the lenders, or their designees, for no consideration, and granted the lenders or their designees an option, exercisable at any time up to December 31, 2009, to purchase an additional 2,000,000 of their Class A shares for $0.25 per share. Effective August 28, 2009, Messrs. Daniel Klaus and Lucas Mann terminated their consulting agreements with the Company and resigned as members of the board of directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. There was no disagreement or dispute between Messrs. Klaus and Mann and the Company which led to their resignation as directors. They also agreed not to sell their remaining shares in the Company for a period of at least six months.
 
On October 14, 2009, the Company entered into an agreement with the stockholders of Whyte Lyon Socratic, Inc., a Delaware corporation, d/b/a “The Institute of Modern Economy” (“Whyte Lyon”), to acquire 100% of the capital stock of such corporation in exchange for 500,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, which the parties valued at $2.00 per share. Closing of the acquisition of the shares of Whyte Lyon occurred on November 2, 2009 following consummation of the transactions contemplated by the Vensure Purchase Agreement; provided, that for all purposes the closing date and delivery of all closing documents and instruments were deemed to have occurred effective on September 29, 2009.  Upon completion of the Company’s acquisition of Whyte Lyon, its principal stockholder, Joseph J. Bianco, became Chairman of the Board of Directors of the Company.
 
 
74

 
 
Effective December 28, 2009, IP Global sold and assigned $91,476 principal amount of its original $2.5 million convertible Note from the Company to Bleecker Holdings Corp., an entity wholly-owned by Joseph J. Bianco, our Chairman of the Board.  In connection with the Debt Restructuring Agreement, Bleecker Holdings exchanged such Note for 43,560 shares of the Company’s Series A Preferred Stock.  Such shares were subsequently sold by Bleecker to an unaffiliated third party.

On April 15, 2010, in consideration for Mr. Bianco serving as Chairman of Weston Capital, the Company assigned to Bleecker Holdings the right to receive a management fee from Weston Capital in the amount of $100,000 per annum, payable monthly.
 
We believe that all these transactions were entered into on terms as favorable as could have been obtained from unrelated third parties because, based upon its experience in the industry, we believe we would have had to pay independent third parties more for comparable assets or services.

Other than the above transactions, we have not entered into any material transactions with any director, executive officer, and nominee for director, beneficial owner of five percent or more of our common stock, or family members of such persons. Also, other than the above transactions, we have not had any transactions with any promoter.

Review, Approval and Ratification of Related Party Transactions
 
The board of directors has responsibility for establishing and maintaining guidelines relating to any related party transactions between the Company and any of its officers or directors. Under the Company’s Code of Ethics, any conflict of interest between a director or officer and the Company must be referred to the non-interested directors for approval. The Company intends to adopt written guidelines for the board of directors which will set forth the requirements for review and approval of any related party transactions.

Director Independence
 
During fiscal 2009 and through the present, we were not and are not required to comply with the director independence requirements of any securities exchange.  In determining whether our directors are independent however, the board of directors applies the requirements for   “independent directors” as defined in the rules and regulations of the NYSE Amex (formerly known as the American Stock Exchange).  The Company’s board of directors determined that Messrs. Biancardi, Eilertsen and Laslop are independent.

Conflicts of Interest
 
Certain potential conflicts of interest are inherent in the relationships between our officers and directors of and us.
 
Conflicts Relating to Officers and Directors
 
To date, we do not believe that there are any conflicts of interest involving our officers or directors.
 
With respect to transactions involving real or apparent conflicts of interest, we have adopted policies and procedures which require that: (i) the fact of the relationship or interest giving rise to the potential conflict be disclosed or known to the directors who authorize or approve the transaction prior to such authorization or approval, (ii) the transaction be approved by a majority of our disinterested outside directors, and (iii) the transaction be fair and reasonable to us at the time it is authorized or approved by our directors.


Audit Fees
 
Audit fees consist of fees billed for professional services rendered for the audit of our consolidated financial statements and review of the interim consolidated financial statements included in quarterly reports and services that are normally provided by Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates in connection with statutory and regulatory filings or engagements.  For our fiscal year ended December 31, 2009, we were billed approximately $57,500 for professional services rendered for the audit and reviews of our financial statements.  For our fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, we were billed approximately $11,250 for professional services rendered for the audit and reviews of our financial statements.
 
 
75

 
 
Audit Related Fees
 
Audit related fees consist of fees billed for assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the audit or review of our consolidated financial statements and are not reported under "Audit Fees".  There were no audit related fees for our fiscal years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.
 
Tax Fees
 
Tax fees consist of fees billed for professional services for tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning.  For our fiscal years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, we were billed approximately $3,000 and $3,500, respectively, related to professional services rendered for tax compliance, tax advice, and tax planning.

All Other Fees
 
All other fees consist of fees for products and services other than the services reported above. The Company did not incur any other fees related to services rendered by Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.

Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures
 
The Company's Audit Committee’s policy is to pre-approve all audit and permissible non-audit services provided by the independent auditors. These services may include audit services, audit-related services, tax services and other services. Pre-approval is generally provided for up to one year and any pre-approval is detailed as to the particular service or category of services and is generally subject to a specific budget. The independent auditors and management are required to periodically report to the Company's Audit Committee regarding the extent of services provided by the independent auditors in accordance with this pre-approval, and the fees for the services performed to date. The Audit Committee may also pre-approve particular services on a case-by-case basis.
 
The Audit Committee has considered whether the provision of non-audit services is compatible with maintaining the principal accountant's independence.
 
PART IV

Item 15.  Exhibits , Financial Statement Schedules.

(a) Financial Statements and Schedules

1. Financial Statements

The following financial statements are filed as part of this report under Item 8 of Part II “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data:

A.           Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2009 and 2008.
 
B.           Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, and from September 20, 2007 (inception) through December 31, 2009.
 
C.           Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the period from September 20, 2007 (inception) through December 31, 2009.
 
D.           Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended of December 31, 2009 and 2008 and from September 20, 2007 (inception) through December 31, 2009.
 
 
76

 
 
2. Financial Statement Schedules

Financial statement schedules not included herein have been omitted because they are either not required, not applicable, or the information is otherwise included herein.

(b) Exhibits.

EXHIBIT INDEX
 
Exhibit No.
 
Description
2.1
 
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of January 15, 2008, between Fund.com Inc. and Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to Form 8-K, filed on January 17, 2008, incorporated by reference).
3.1
 
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Eastern Services Holdings, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 3.1 to  Form 8-K, filed on January 17, 2008, incorporated by reference).
3.2
 
Bylaws of Fund.com. (Filed as Exhibit 3.2 to Form 8-K, filed on January 17, 2008, incorporated by reference).
3.3
 
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Fund.com Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 3.1 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
4.1
 
Form of Common Stock Subscription Agreement (Filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Form 8-K, filed on January 15, 2008, incorporated by reference).
4.2
 
Subscription Agreement, dated as of November 12, 2007, between Meade Technologies Inc. and Equities Media Acquisition Corp Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 4.2 to Form 8-K, filed on January 15, 2008, incorporated by reference).
4.3
 
Form of Common Stock Purchase Warrant to Purchase Common Stock to IP Global, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 4.3 to Form 10-K, filed on May 7, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
4.4
 
Certificate of Designations for Fund.com Inc.’s Series A Convertible Preferred Stock (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on January 16, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.1
 
Fund.com Inc. 2007 Stock Incentive Plan (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed on January 17, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.2
 
Employment Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2007, between Meade Technologies Inc. and Raymond Lang (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on January 17, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.3
 
Employment Agreement, dated as of October 30, 2007, between Meade Technologies Inc. and Michael Hlavsa (Filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K, filed on January 15, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.4
 
Certificate of Deposit Agreement, dated as of November 9, 2007 between Meade Capital Inc. and Global Bank of Commerce Limited (Filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K, filed on January 17, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.5
 
Consulting Agreement between the Company and Fabric Group, LLC  (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K filed on March 10, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
10.6
 
Consulting Agreement between the Company and MKL Consulting Ltd. (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K filed on March 10, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
10.7
 
License Agreement between Fund.com Managed Products Inc. and Equities Global Communications, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K, filed on March 10, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.8
 
Employment Agreement between the Company and Gregory Webster (Filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K, filed on March 10, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.9
 
Employment Agreement between the Company and Philip Gentile (Filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Form 8-K, filed on March 10, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.10
 
Form of Indemnification Agreement (Filed as Exhibit 10.10 to Form 8-K, filed on March 10, 2008, incorporated by reference).
10.11
 
Purchase and Contribution Agreement (Filed as Exhibit 10.11 to Form 10-K, filed on November 30, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.12
 
Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of AdvisorShares Investments LLC (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on November 6, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
10.13
 
Employment agreement with Noah Hammon (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K, filed on November 6, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
77

 
 
10.14
 
Securities Purchase Agreement with National Holdings Corporation (Filed as Exhibit 10.14 to Form 10-K, filed on November 30, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.15
 
Limited Recourse Note dated April 8, 2009 between Fund.com Inc. and National Holdings Corporation (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on April 14, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
10.16
 
Pledge Agreement dated April 8, 2009 between Fund.com Inc. and Global Asset Fund Limited (Filed as Exhibit 10.16 to Form 10-K, filed on November 30, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.17
 
Demand Promissory Note dated April 8, 2009 between Fund.com Inc. and Global Asset Fund Limited (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K, filed on April 14, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
10.18
 
Revolving Credit Loan Agreement dated as of April 30, 2009 and effective as of May 1, 2009 with IP Global Investors Ltd. (Filed as Exhibit 10.18 to Form 10-K, filed on May 7, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
10.19
 
Guaranty Agreement dated as of April 30, 2009 and effective as of May 1, 2009 with the Company’s subsidiaries in favor of IP Global Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.19 to Form 10-K, filed on May 7, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
10. 20
 
Revolving Credit Convertible Note dated April 30, 2009 between Fund.com Inc. and IP Global Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.20 to Form 10-K, filed on May 7, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
10. 21
 
Amendment to Securities Purchase Agreement with National Holdings Corporation (Filed as Exhibit 10.21 to Form 10-K, filed on May 7, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
10.22
 
Amendment No. 2 to Securities Purchase Agreement with National Holdings Corporation (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 10-Q, filed on May 15, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
10.23
 
Revolving Credit Loan Agreement dated as of August 28, 2009 by and among Fund.com Inc., IP Global Investors Ltd., and Equities Media Acquisition Corp. Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.24
 
Guaranty Agreement dated as of August 28, 2009 by and among Fund.com Inc., IP Global Investors Ltd., and Equities Media Acquisition Corp. Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.25
 
Revolving Credit Convertible Note of Fund.com Inc. dated as of August 28, 2009 (Filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.26
 
Option to Purchase Shares of Fund.com Inc. dated as of August 28, 2009 (Filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.27
 
Stock Purchase, Stock Redemption and Option to Purchase Shares of Fund.com Inc. dated as of August 28, 2009 (Filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.28
 
Warrant to Purchase Shares of Class A Common Stock of Fund.com Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.6 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.29
 
Separation Agreement dated as of August 28, 2009 by and between Fund.com Inc. and Lucas Mann (Filed as Exhibit 10.7 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.30
 
Separation Agreement dated as of August 28, 2009 by and between Fund.com Inc. and Daniel Klaus (Filed as Exhibit 10.8 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.31
 
Secured Non-Negotiable Non-Interest Bearing Installment Promissory Note of IP Global Investors Ltd. dated as of August 28, 2009 in favor of Daniel Klaus (Filed as Exhibit 10.9 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.32
 
Secured Non-Negotiable Non-Interest Bearing Installment Promissory Note of IP Global Investors Ltd. dated as of August 28, 2009 in favor of Lucas Mann (Filed as Exhibit 10.10 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.33
 
Pledge Agreement as of August 28, 2009 by and between IP Global Investors Ltd., Hodgson Russ LLP as collateral agent, and Daniel Klaus (Filed as Exhibit 10.11 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.34
 
Pledge Agreement as of August 28, 2009 by and between IP Global Investors Ltd., Hodgson Russ LLP as collateral agent, and Lucas Mann (Filed as Exhibit 10.12 to Form 8-K, filed on September 3, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.35
 
Securities Purchase Agreement dated September 24, 2009 by and among Fund.com Inc., Vensure Employer Services, Inc. and the stockholders of Vensure Employer Services, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed on November 5, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.36
 
Restated Articles of Incorporation of Vensure Employer Services, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on November 5, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.37
 
Form of Stockholders Agreement among Fund.com Inc., Vensure Employer Services, Inc. and the stockholders of Vensure Employer Services, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K, filed on November 5, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.38
 
Form of Content Agreement between Fund.com Inc., Vensure Employer Services, Inc., Whyte Lyon Socratic Inc. and Vensure Retirement Administration, Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K, filed on November 5, 2009, incorporated by reference).
 
 
78

 
 
10.39
 
Stock Purchase Agreement among Joseph J. Bianco, Whyte Lyon Socratic Inc. and Fund.com Inc. (Filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Form 8-K, filed on November 5, 2009, incorporated by reference).
10.40
 
Debt Restructuring Letter Agreement dated December 28, 2009 by and among Fund.com Inc., IP Global Investors Ltd., Equities Media Acquisition Corp. and the other parties thereto (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed on January 16, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.41
 
Form of Subscription Agreement for the Option Shares (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed on February 16, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.42
 
Securities Purchase and Restructuring Agreement dated as of March 26, 2010 by and among Fund.com Inc., Weston Capital Management, LLC, PBC-Weston Capital Holdings, LLC, Albert Hallac and the other persons who are parties signatory thereto (Filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Form 8-K, filed on April 2, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.43
 
Fifth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Weston Capital Management, LLC (Filed as Exhibit 10.2 to Form 8-K, filed on April 2, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.44
 
Warrant to Purchase Class A Common Stock of Fund.com Inc. issued to PBC- Weston Capital Holdings, LLC (Filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Form 8-K, filed on April 2, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.45
 
$5,000,000 Senior Secured Promissory Note of Fund.com Inc. issued to the Hallac Members LLC (Filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Form 8-K, filed on April 2, 2010, incorporated by reference).
10.46
 
Pledge and Security Agreement dated as of March 26, 2010 by and among Fund.com Inc., the Hallac Members and Zukerman Gore Brandeis & Crossman, LLP, as collateral agent LLC (Filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Form 8-K, filed on April 2, 2010, incorporated by reference).
21.1
 
Subsidiaries of the Registrant*
14.1
 
Code of Ethics (Filed as Exhibit 14.1 to Form 10-K, filed on May 7, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
16.1
 
Letter from Jewett, Schwartz, Wolfe & Associates dated as of November 30, 2009 (Filed as Exhibit 16.1 to Form 8-K, filed on November 30, 2009, incorporated by reference).
31.1
 
Certification of principal executive officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350 - Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002*
31.2
 
Certification of principal financial officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350 - Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002*
32.1
 
Certification of the chief executive officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002*
32.2
 
Certification of the chief financial officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002*
99.1
 
Order under Section 6(c) of the Investment Company Act of 1940 Granting Exemptions from Sections 2(a)(32), 5(a)(1) and 22(d) of the Act and Rule 22c-1 under the Act and Under Sections 6(c) and 17(b) of the Act Granting Exemptions from Sections 17(a)(1) and (2) of the Act and Denying a Request for Hearing (Filed as Exhibit 99.1 to Form 8-K, filed July 27, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
99.2
 
Notice dated July 21, 2009 from AdvisorShares Investments LLC to the Company re: Achievement of Milestone A – SEC Exemptive Order (Filed as Exhibit 99.1 to Form 8-K, filed July 27, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
* Filed herewith

 
79

 

 
SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, the registrant has duly caused this Form 10-K Annual Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned on April 23, 2010, thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
  FUND.COM INC.  
     
 
/s/ Gregory Webster
 
 
Gregory Webster
 
 
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)
 
     
     
 
/s/ Michael Hlavsa
 
 
Michael Hlavsa
 
 
Chief Financial Officer (Principal Accounting and Financial Officer)
 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Form 10-K Annual Report has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signature
 
Position
 
Date
         
/s/ Joseph J. Bianco
 
Chairman of the Board of Directors
 
April 23, 2010
Joseph J. Bianco
       
         
/s/ Gregory Webster
 
Chief Executive Officer and Director
 
April 23, 2010
Gregory Webster
       
         
/s/ Ivar Eilertsen
 
Director
 
April 23, 2010
Ivar Eilertsen
       
         
/s/ Raul Biancardi
 
Director
 
April 23, 2010
Raul Biancardi
       
         
/s/ Keith Laslop
 
Director
 
April 23, 2010
Keith Laslop
       
 
 
80